Mdse Series
Mdse Series
Thank you for selecting the Mitsubishi numerical control unit. This instruction manual describes the handling and
caution points for using this AC servo/spindle. Incorrect handling may lead to unforeseen accidents, so always read
this instruction manual thoroughly to ensure correct usage.
Make sure that this instruction manual is delivered to the end user. Always store this manual in a safe place.
In order to confirm if all function specifications described in this manual are applicable, refer to the specifications for
each CNC.
(1) Since the description of this specification manual deals with NC in general, for the specifications of individual
machine tools, refer to the manuals issued by the respective machine tool builders. The "restrictions" and
"available functions" described in the manuals issued by the machine tool builders have precedence to those
in this manual.
(2) This manual describes as many special operations as possible, but it should be kept in mind that items not
mentioned in this manual cannot be performed.
Please read this manual and auxiliary documents before starting installation, operation, maintenance or inspection
to ensure correct usage. Thoroughly understand the device, safety information and precautions before starting
operation.
The safety precautions in this instruction manual are ranked as "WARNING" and "CAUTION".
DANGER
When there is a potential risk of fatal or serious injuries if handling is mistaken.
WARNING
When a dangerous situation, or fatal or serious injuries may occur if handling is mistaken.
CAUTION
When a dangerous situation may occur if handling is mistaken leading to medium or minor injuries, or physical damage.
Note that some items described as " CAUTION" may lead to major results depending on the situation. In any
case, important information that must be observed is described.
The signs indicating prohibited and mandatory matters are explained below.
Disassembly is
Prohibited KEEP FIRE AWAY General instruction Earth ground
prohibited
After reading this specifications and instructions manual, store it where the user can access it easily for reference.
The numeric control unit is configured of the control unit, operation board, servo drive unit, spindle drive unit, power
supply, servo motor and spindle motor, etc.
In this section "Precautions for safety", the following items are generically called the "motor".
• Servo motor
• Linear servo motor
• Spindle motor
• Direct-drive motor
In this section "Precautions for safety", the following items are generically called the "unit".
• Servo drive unit
• Spindle drive unit
• Power supply unit
• Scale interface unit
• Magnetic pole detection unit
POINT
Important matters that should be understood for operation of this machine are indicated as a POINT in this manual.
2. Injury prevention
Do not apply a voltage other than that specified in this manual, on each terminal. Failure to observe this
item could lead to ruptures or damage, etc.
Do not mistake the terminal connections. Failure to observe this item could lead to ruptures or damage,
etc.
Do not mistake the polarity (+,- ). Failure to observe this item could lead to ruptures or damage, etc.
Do not touch the radiation fin on unit back face, regenerative resistor or motor, etc., or place parts (cables,
etc.) while the power is turned ON or immediately after turning the power OFF. These parts may reach high
temperatures, and can cause burns or part damage.
Structure the cooling fan on the unit back face, etc., so that it cannot be touched after installation.
Touching the cooling fan during operation could lead to injuries.
Take care not to suck hair, clothes, etc. into the cooling fan.
CAUTION
3. Various precautions
Observe the following precautions. Incorrect handling of the unit could lead to faults, injuries and electric shocks, etc.
Do not hold the cables, axis or encoder when transporting the motor.
Do not hold the connected wires or cables when transporting the units.
Do not hold the front cover when transporting the unit. The unit could drop.
Always observe the installation directions of the units or motors.
Secure the specified distance between the units and control panel, or between the servo drive unit and
other devices.
Do not install or run a unit or motor that is damaged or missing parts.
Do not block the intake or exhaust ports of the motor provided with a cooling fan.
Do not let foreign objects enter the units or motors. In particular, if conductive objects such as screws or
metal chips, etc., or combustible materials such as oil enter, rupture or breakage could occur.
Provide adequate protection using a material such as connector for conduit to prevent screws, metallic
detritus, water and other conductive matter or oil and other combustible matter from entering the motor
through the power line lead-out port.
The units, motors and encoders are precision devices, so do not drop them or apply strong impacts to
them.
Always operate the motor, which has a shaft with keyway, with the key attached.
CAUTION
Store and use the units under the following environment conditions.
(5) Troubleshooting
If a hazardous situation is predicted during power failure or product trouble, use a servo motor with
magnetic brakes or install an external brake mechanism.
Always turn the main circuit power of the motor OFF when an alarm occurs.
If an alarm occurs, remove the cause, and secure the safety before resetting the alarm.
CAUTION
(6) Maintenance, inspection and part replacement
Always backup the programs and parameters before starting maintenance or inspections.
The capacity of the electrolytic capacitor will drop over time due to self-discharging, etc. To prevent
secondary disasters due to failures, replacing this part every five years when used under a normal
environment is recommended. Contact the Service Center, Service Station, Sales Office or dealer for
repairs or part replacement.
Never perform a megger test (measure the insulation resistance) of the drive unit. Failure to observe this
could lead to faults.
If the battery low warning is issued, immediately replace the battery. Replace the batteries while applying
the drive unit's control power.
Do not short circuit, charge, overheat, incinerate or disassemble the battery.
For after-purchase servicing of the built-in motor, only the servicing parts for MITSUBISHI encoder can be
supplied. For the motor body, prepare the spare parts at the machine tool builders.
For maintenance, part replacement, and services in case of failures in the built-in motor (including the
encoder), take necessary actions at the machine tool builders. For drive unit, Mitsubishi can offer the after-
purchase servicing as with the general drive unit.
(7) Disposal
Take the batteries and backlights for LCD, etc., off from the controller, drive unit and motor, and dispose of
them as general industrial wastes.
Do not disassemble the unit or motor.
Dispose of the battery according to local laws.
Always return the secondary side (magnet side) of the linear servo motor to the Service Center or Service
Station.
When incinerating optical communication cable, hydrogen fluoride gas or hydrogen chloride gas which is
corrosive and harmful may be generated. For disposal of optical communication cable, request for
specialized industrial waste disposal services that has incineration facility for disposing hydrogen fluoride
gas or hydrogen chloride gas.
(8) Transportation
The unit and motor are precision parts and must be handled carefully.
According to a United Nations Advisory, the battery unit and battery must be transported according to the
rules set forth by the International Civil Aviation Organization (ICAO), International Air Transportation
Association (IATA), International Maritime Organization (IMO), and United States Department of
Transportation (DOT), etc.
The following two laws will apply when disposing of this product. Considerations must be made to each law.
The following laws are in effect in Japan. Thus, when using this product overseas, the local laws will have a
priority. If necessary, indicate or notify these laws to the final user of the product.
Your MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC product is designed and manufactured with high quality materials and
components which can be recycled and/or reused.
This symbol means that batteries and accumulators, at their end-of-life, should be disposed of
separately from your household waste.
If a chemical symbol is printed beneath the symbol shown above, this chemical symbol means that the
battery or accumulator contains a heavy metal at a certain concentration. This will be indicated as
follows:
Hg: mercury (0,0005%), Cd: cadmium (0,002%), Pb: lead (0,004%)
In the European Union there are separate collection systems for used batteries and accumulators.
Please, dispose of batteries and accumulators correctly at your local community waste collection/
recycling centre.
MELDAS, MELSEC, EZSocket, EZMotion, iQ Platform, MELSOFT, GOT, CC-Link, CC-Link/LT and CC-Link
IE are either trademarks or registered trademarks of Mitsubishi Electric Corporation in Japan and/or other
countries.
Other company and product names that appear in this manual are trademarks or registered trademarks of the
respective companies.
本製品の取扱いについて
( 日本語 /Japanese)
本製品は工業用 ( クラス A) 電磁環境適合機器です。販売者あるいは使用者はこの点に注意し、住商業環境以外で
の使用をお願いいたします。
(English)
This is a class A product. In a domestic environment this product may cause radio interference in which case the
user may be required to take adequate measures.
( 한국어 /Korean)
이 기기는 업무용 (A 급 ) 전자파적합기기로서 판매자 또는 사용자는 이 점을 주의하시기 바라며 가정외의 지역에
서 사용하는 것을 목적으로 합니다 .
Contents
1 Installation .................................................................................................................................................... 1
1.1 Installation of Servo Motor..................................................................................................................................... 2
1.1.1 Environmental Conditions ............................................................................................................................ 2
1.1.2 Quakeproof Level ........................................................................................................................................... 3
1.1.3 Cautions for Mounting Load (Prevention of Impact on Shaft) ................................................................... 4
1.1.4 Installation Direction ...................................................................................................................................... 4
1.1.5 Shaft Characteristics ..................................................................................................................................... 5
1.1.6 Machine Accuracy .......................................................................................................................................... 6
1.1.7 Coupling with the Load.................................................................................................................................. 7
1.1.8 Oil / Water Standards ..................................................................................................................................... 8
1.1.9 Installation of Servo Motor .......................................................................................................................... 11
1.1.10 Cable Stress................................................................................................................................................ 11
1.2 Installation of Spindle Motor................................................................................................................................ 12
1.2.1 Environmental Conditions .......................................................................................................................... 12
1.2.2 Balancing the Spindle Motor (Unit)............................................................................................................. 13
1.2.3 Shaft Characteristics ................................................................................................................................... 15
1.2.4 Machine Accuracy ........................................................................................................................................ 15
1.2.5 Coupling with the Fittings ........................................................................................................................... 16
1.2.6 Installation of Rotary Joint and Coolant Joint (Hollow Shaft Specifications) ........................................ 16
1.2.7 Ambient Environment .................................................................................................................................. 22
1.2.8 Installation of Spindle Motor ....................................................................................................................... 22
1.2.9 Connection.................................................................................................................................................... 23
1.2.10 Cable............................................................................................................................................................ 24
1.3 Installation of Tool Spindle Motor ....................................................................................................................... 25
1.3.1 Environmental Conditions .......................................................................................................................... 25
1.3.2 Shaft Characteristics ................................................................................................................................... 25
1.3.3 Installation of Tool Spindle Motor............................................................................................................... 25
1.4 Installation of the Drive Unit ................................................................................................................................ 26
1.4.1 Environmental Conditions .......................................................................................................................... 26
1.4.2 Installation Direction and Clearance .......................................................................................................... 27
1.4.3 Prevention of Entering of Foreign Matter................................................................................................... 29
1.4.4 Panel Installation Hole Work Drawings (Panel Cut Drawings)................................................................. 30
1.4.5 Heating Value................................................................................................................................................ 32
1.4.6 Heat Radiation Countermeasures............................................................................................................... 33
1.5 Installation of the Machine End Encoder............................................................................................................ 36
1.5.1 Spindle Side ABZ Pulse Output Encoder (OSE-1024 Series)................................................................... 36
1.5.2 Spindle Side PLG Serial Output Encoder (TS5690, MU1606 Series) ....................................................... 37
1.6 Noise Measures..................................................................................................................................................... 43
2 Wiring and Connection.............................................................................................................................. 45
2.1 Part System Connection Diagram ....................................................................................................................... 47
2.2 Main Circuit Terminal Block/Control Circuit Connector.................................................................................... 48
2.2.1 Names and Applications of Main Circuit Terminal Block Signals and Control Circuit Connectors..... 48
2.2.2 Connector Pin Assignment ......................................................................................................................... 49
2.2.3 Servo Motor Power Supply Connector Wiring Method............................................................................. 60
2.3 NC and Drive Unit Connection............................................................................................................................. 62
2.3.1 Connection of Optical Communication Cables ......................................................................................... 62
2.3.2 Drive Unit Arrangement ............................................................................................................................... 65
2.4 Motor and Encoder Connection........................................................................................................................... 66
2.4.1 Connection of the Servo Motor ................................................................................................................... 66
2.4.2 Connection of the Full-closed Loop System ............................................................................................. 71
2.4.3 Connection of the Speed Command Synchronization Control System .................................................. 73
2.4.4 Connection of the Spindle Motor ................................................................................................................ 75
2.4.5 Connection of Tool Spindle Motor.............................................................................................................. 77
2.5 Connection of Power Supply ............................................................................................................................... 80
2.5.1 Power Supply Input Connection ................................................................................................................. 80
2.5.2 Connection of the Grounding Cable........................................................................................................... 82
2.6 Wiring of the Motor Brake ................................................................................................................................... 83
2.6.1 Wiring of the Motor Magnetic Brake ........................................................................................................... 83
2.6.2 Dynamic Brake Unit Wiring ......................................................................................................................... 87
2.7 Peripheral Control Wiring..................................................................................................................................... 88
2.7.1 Input/Output Circuit Wiring ......................................................................................................................... 88
2.7.2 Specified Speed Output ............................................................................................................................... 91
2.7.3 Spindle Coil Changeover............................................................................................................................. 93
2.7.4 Proximity Switch Orientation ...................................................................................................................... 97
3 Safety Function ........................................................................................................................................ 101
3.1 Safety Function................................................................................................................................................... 102
3.1.1 Harmonized Standard ................................................................................................................................ 102
3.1.2 Outline of Safety Function ........................................................................................................................ 102
3.2 STO (Safe Torque Off) Function ........................................................................................................................ 103
3.3 SBC (Safe Brake Control) Function .................................................................................................................. 109
4 Setup ......................................................................................................................................................... 111
4.1 Initial Setup ......................................................................................................................................................... 112
4.1.1 Setting the Rotary Switch.......................................................................................................................... 112
4.1.2 Setting DIP Switch ..................................................................................................................................... 113
4.1.3 Transition of LED Display After Power Is Turned ON............................................................................. 114
4.2 Setting the Initial Parameters for the Servo Drive Unit ................................................................................... 115
4.2.1 Setting of Servo Specification Parameters.............................................................................................. 116
4.2.2 Setting of Machine Side Encoder ............................................................................................................. 118
4.2.3 Setting of Distance-coded Reference Scale ............................................................................................ 122
4.2.4 Setting of Speed Command Synchronous Control ................................................................................ 124
4.2.5 List of Standard Parameters for Each Servo Motor................................................................................ 125
4.2.6 Servo Parameters ...................................................................................................................................... 131
4.3 Setting the Initial Parameters for the Spindle Drive Unit ................................................................................ 165
4.3.1 Setting of Parameters Related to the Spindle ......................................................................................... 165
4.3.2 List of Standard Parameters for Each Spindle Motor............................................................................. 171
4.3.3 Spindle Parameters.................................................................................................................................... 213
5 Servo Adjustment .................................................................................................................................... 247
5.1 Servo Adjustment Procedure ............................................................................................................................ 248
5.2 Gain Adjustment ................................................................................................................................................. 249
5.2.1 Current Loop Gain ..................................................................................................................................... 249
5.2.2 Speed Loop Gain........................................................................................................................................ 250
5.2.3 Position Loop Gain .................................................................................................................................... 255
5.2.4 OMR-FF Function ....................................................................................................................................... 258
5.3 Characteristics Improvement ............................................................................................................................ 264
5.3.1 Optimal Adjustment of Cycle Time........................................................................................................... 264
5.3.2 Vibration Suppression Measures ............................................................................................................. 267
5.3.3 Improving the Cutting Surface Precision ................................................................................................ 274
5.3.4 Improvement of Characteristics during Acceleration/Deceleration...................................................... 277
5.3.5 Improvement of Protrusion at Quadrant Changeover ............................................................................ 281
5.3.6 Improvement of Overshooting.................................................................................................................. 285
5.3.7 Improvement of the Interpolation Control Path ...................................................................................... 288
5.4 Adjustment during Full Closed Loop Control .................................................................................................. 290
5.4.1 Outline......................................................................................................................................................... 290
5.4.2 Speed Loop Delay Compensation ............................................................................................................ 291
5.4.3 Dual Feedback Control .............................................................................................................................. 292
5.4.4 Full-closed Torsion Compensation Function.......................................................................................... 294
5.5 Settings for Emergency Stop ............................................................................................................................ 297
5.5.1 Deceleration Control.................................................................................................................................. 297
5.5.2 Vertical Axis Drop Prevention Control..................................................................................................... 300
5.5.3 Vertical Axis Pull-up Control..................................................................................................................... 307
5.6 Protective Functions .......................................................................................................................................... 308
5.6.1 Overload Detection .................................................................................................................................... 308
5.6.2 Excessive Error Detection......................................................................................................................... 309
5.6.3 Collision Detection Function .................................................................................................................... 310
5.7 Servo Control Signal .......................................................................................................................................... 314
5.7.1 Servo Control Input (NC to Servo)............................................................................................................ 314
5.7.2 Servo Control Output (Servo to NC)......................................................................................................... 317
6 Spindle Adjustment ................................................................................................................................. 321
6.1 Adjustment Procedures for Each Control ........................................................................................................ 322
6.1.1 Basic Adjustments..................................................................................................................................... 322
6.1.2 Gain Adjustment ........................................................................................................................................ 323
6.1.3 Adjusting the Acceleration/Deceleration Operation ............................................................................... 327
6.1.4 Orientation Adjustment ............................................................................................................................. 334
6.1.5 Synchronous Tapping Adjustment .......................................................................................................... 338
6.1.6 High-speed Synchronous Tapping........................................................................................................... 341
6.1.7 Spindle C Axis Adjustment (For Lathe System) ...................................................................................... 347
6.1.8 Spindle Synchronization Adjustment (For Lathe System) ..................................................................... 352
6.1.9 Deceleration Coil Changeover Valid Function by Emergency Stop ...................................................... 354
6.1.10 High-response Acceleration/Deceleration Function ............................................................................. 355
6.1.11 Spindle Cutting Withstand Level Improvement..................................................................................... 356
6.1.12 Spindle Motor Temperature Compensation Function........................................................................... 357
6.2 Settings for Emergency Stop............................................................................................................................. 362
6.2.1 Deceleration Control .................................................................................................................................. 362
6.3 Spindle Control Signal........................................................................................................................................ 363
6.3.1 Spindle Control Input (NC to Spindle) ...................................................................................................... 363
6.3.2 Spindle Control Output (Spindle to NC) ................................................................................................... 368
7 Troubleshooting....................................................................................................................................... 373
7.1 Points of Caution and Confirmation.................................................................................................................. 374
7.1.1 LED Display When Alarm or Warning Occurs ......................................................................................... 375
7.2 Protective Functions List of Units..................................................................................................................... 376
7.2.1 List of Alarms ............................................................................................................................................. 376
7.2.2 List of Warnings ......................................................................................................................................... 385
7.3 Troubleshooting.................................................................................................................................................. 387
7.3.1 Troubleshooting at Power ON................................................................................................................... 387
7.3.2 Troubleshooting for Each Alarm No......................................................................................................... 388
7.3.3 Troubleshooting for Each Warning No..................................................................................................... 414
7.3.4 Parameter Numbers during Initial Parameter Error ................................................................................ 417
7.3.5 Troubleshooting the Spindle System When There Is No Alarm or Warning ........................................ 420
7.3.6 Details of Alarm 4D .................................................................................................................................... 422
8 Maintenance ............................................................................................................................................. 425
8.1 Periodic Inspections ........................................................................................................................................... 426
8.1.1 Inspections ................................................................................................................................................. 426
8.1.2 Cleaning of Spindle Motor ......................................................................................................................... 426
8.2 Service Parts ....................................................................................................................................................... 438
8.3 Adding and Replacing Units and Parts............................................................................................................. 439
8.3.1 Replacing the Drive Unit ............................................................................................................................ 439
8.3.2 Replacing the Unit Fan .............................................................................................................................. 440
8.3.3 Replacing the Battery ................................................................................................................................ 442
9 Power Backup System............................................................................................................................. 445
9.1 Deceleration and Stop Function at Power Failure ........................................................................................... 446
9.1.1 Specifications of Stop Method for Deceleration and Stop Function at Power Failure System .......... 446
9.1.2 Wiring of Deceleration and Stop Function at Power Failure .................................................................. 447
9.1.3 Setup of Deceleration and Stop Function at Power Failure ................................................................... 448
9.2 Retraction function at power failure.................................................................................................................. 450
9.2.1 Wiring of Retraction Function at Power Failure ...................................................................................... 450
9.2.2 Setup of Retraction Function at Power Failure System.......................................................................... 453
9.3 Explanation of Each Part of Power Backup System........................................................................................ 455
9.3.1 How to Set Rotary Switch and Dip Switches ........................................................................................... 455
9.3.2 Transition of LED Display After Power Is Turned ON ............................................................................. 455
9.4 Troubleshooting for Power Backup System .................................................................................................... 456
9.4.1 LED Display When Alarm or Warning Occurs ......................................................................................... 456
9.4.2 List of Power Backup Function Alarms.................................................................................................... 457
9.4.3 List of Power Backup Function Warnings ............................................................................................... 457
9.4.4 Troubleshooting for Each Alarm No......................................................................................................... 458
9.4.5 Troubleshooting for Each Warning No..................................................................................................... 461
9.4.6 Trouble Shooting at Power ON ................................................................................................................. 462
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly............................................................................................ 463
10.1 CMV1-xPxxS-xx Plug Connector ..................................................................................................................... 464
10.2 1747464-1 Plug Connector ............................................................................................................................... 470
10.2.1 Applicable Products................................................................................................................................. 470
10.2.2 Applicable Cable ...................................................................................................................................... 470
10.2.3 Related Documents .................................................................................................................................. 470
10.2.4 Assembly Procedure................................................................................................................................ 470
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit.............................................................................. 473
11.1 D/A Output Specifications................................................................................................................................ 474
11.2 Output Data Settings ........................................................................................................................................ 475
11.2.1 Servo Drive Unit Settings ........................................................................................................................ 475
11.2.2 Spindle Drive Unit Settings ..................................................................................................................... 477
11.3 Setting the Output Magnification .................................................................................................................... 480
11.3.1 Servo Drive Unit Settings ........................................................................................................................ 480
11.3.2 Spindle Drive Unit Settings ..................................................................................................................... 481
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function ................................................................................................................ 483
12.1 Protection Function.......................................................................................................................................... 484
12.1.1 Outline of Protection Function ............................................................................................................... 484
12.2 Emergency Stop Observation ......................................................................................................................... 485
12.3 SLS (Safely Limited Speed) function .............................................................................................................. 488
13 Appx. 4: Compliance to EC Directives ................................................................................................. 493
13.1 Compliance to EC Directives........................................................................................................................... 494
13.1.1 European EC Directives .......................................................................................................................... 494
13.1.2 Cautions for EC Directive Compliance .................................................................................................. 494
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines................................................................................................... 497
14.1 Introduction....................................................................................................................................................... 498
14.2 EMC Instructions .............................................................................................................................................. 498
14.3 EMC Measures .................................................................................................................................................. 499
14.4 Measures for Panel Structure.......................................................................................................................... 499
14.4.1 Measures for Control Panel Unit ............................................................................................................ 499
14.4.2 Measures for Door .................................................................................................................................. 500
14.4.3 Measures for Operation Board Panel..................................................................................................... 500
14.4.4 Shielding of the Power Supply Input Section........................................................................................ 500
14.5 Measures for Various Cables .......................................................................................................................... 501
14.5.1 Measures for Wiring in Panel.................................................................................................................. 501
14.5.2 Measures for Shield Treatment............................................................................................................... 501
14.5.3 Servo/Spindle Motor Power Cable.......................................................................................................... 502
14.5.4 Servo/Spindle Motor Encoder Cable ...................................................................................................... 503
14.6 EMC Countermeasure Parts ............................................................................................................................ 504
14.6.1 Shield Clamp Fitting ................................................................................................................................ 504
14.6.2 Ferrite Core............................................................................................................................................... 504
14.6.3 Power Line Filter ...................................................................................................................................... 506
14.6.4 Surge Absorber ........................................................................................................................................ 507
15 Appx. 6: Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure Guidelines ........................................................... 509
15.1 Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure Guidelines ..................................................................................... 510
15.1.1 Calculating the Equivalent Capacity of the Higher Harmonic Generator ........................................... 511
Outline for MDS-E/EH Series 3.2.9 HAS Control
3.2.10 OMR-FF Control
Specifications Manual 3.2.11 Control Loop Gain Changeover
(IB-1501226-G) 3.2.12 Spindle Output Stabilizing Control
3.2.13 High-response Spindle Acceleration/Decelera-
tion Function
1 Introduction 3.3 Compensation Control Function
1.1 Servo/Spindle Drive System Configuration 3.3.1 Jitter Compensation
1.1.1 System Configuration 3.3.2 Notch Filter
1.2 Explanation of Type 3.3.3 Adaptive Tracking-type Notch Filter
1.2.1 Servo Motor Type 3.3.4 Overshooting Compensation
1.2.2 Servo Drive Unit Type 3.3.5 Machine End Compensation Control
1.2.3 Spindle Motor Type 3.3.6 Lost Motion Compensation Type 2
1.2.4 Tool Spindle Motor Type 3.3.7 Lost Motion Compensation Type 3
1.2.5 Spindle Drive Unit Type 3.3.8 Spindle Motor Temperature Compensation Func-
1.2.6 Power Supply Unit Type tion
1.2.7 AC Reactor Type 3.3.9 Real-time Tuning I
3.3.10 Full-closed Torsion Compensation Function
2 Specifications
3.4 Protection Function
2.1 Servo Motor
3.4.1 Deceleration Control at Emergency Stop
2.1.1 Specifications List
3.4.2 Vertical Axis Drop Prevention/Pull-up Control
2.1.2 Torque Characteristics
3.4.3 Earth Fault Detection
2.2 Spindle Motor
3.4.4 Collision Detection Function
2.2.1 Specifications
3.4.5 Fan Stop Detection
2.2.2 Output Characteristics
3.4.6 Open-phase Detection
2.3 Tool Spindle Motor
3.4.7 Contactor Weld Detection
2.3.1 Specifications
3.4.8 STO (Safe Torque Off) Function
2.3.2 Output Characteristics
3.4.9 SBC (Safe Brake Control) Function
2.4 Drive Unit
3.4.10 Deceleration and Stop Function at Power Fail-
2.4.1 Installation Environment Conditions
ure
2.4.2 Servo Drive Unit
3.4.11 Retraction Function at Power Failure
2.4.3 Spindle Drive Unit
3.5 Sequence Functions
2.4.4 Power Supply Unit
3.5.1 Contactor Control Function
2.4.5 Unit Outline Dimension Drawing
3.5.2 Motor Brake Control Function
2.4.6 AC Reactor
3.5.3 External Emergency Stop Function
2.4.7 Explanation of Each Part
3.5.4 Specified Speed Output
3 Function Specifications 3.5.5 Quick READY ON Sequence
Function Specifications List 3.6 Diagnosis Function
3.1 Base Control Functions 3.6.1 Monitor Output Function
3.1.1 Full Closed Loop Control 3.6.2 Machine Resonance Frequency Display Function
3.1.2 Position Command Synchronous Control 3.6.3 Machine Inertia Display Function
3.1.3 Speed Command Synchronous Control 3.6.4 Motor Temperature Display Function
3.1.4 Distance-coded Reference Position Control 3.6.5 Load Monitor Output Function
3.1.5 Spindle's Continuous Position Loop Control 3.6.6 Power Supply Diagnosis Display Function
3.1.6 Coil Changeover Control 3.6.7 Drive Unit Diagnosis Display Function
3.1.7 Gear Changeover Control 4 Characteristics
3.1.8 Orientation Control
4.1 Servo Motor
3.1.9 Indexing Control
4.1.1 Environmental Conditions
3.1.10 Synchronous Tapping Control
4.1.2 Quakeproof Level
3.1.11 Spindle Synchronous Control
4.1.3 Shaft Characteristics
3.1.12 Spindle/C Axis Control
4.1.4 Machine Accuracy
3.1.13 Proximity Switch Orientation Control
4.1.5 Oil/Water Standards
3.1.14 Power Regeneration Control
4.1.6 Installation of Servo Motor
3.1.15 Resistor Regeneration Control
4.1.7 Overload Protection Characteristics
3.2 Servo/Spindle Control Functions
4.1.8 Magnetic Brake
3.2.1 Torque Limit Function
4.1.9 Dynamic Brake Characteristics
3.2.2 Variable Speed Loop Gain Control
4.2 Spindle Motor
3.2.3 Gain Changeover for Synchronous Tapping Con-
4.2.1 Environmental Conditions
trol
4.2.2 Shaft Characteristics
3.2.4 Speed Loop PID Changeover Control
4.2.3 Machine Accuracy
3.2.5 Disturbance Torque Observer
4.2.4 Installation of Spindle Motor
3.2.6 Smooth High Gain Control (SHG Control)
4.3 Tool Spindle Motor
3.2.7 High-speed Synchronous Tapping Control (OMR-
4.3.1 Environmental Conditions
DD Control)
4.3.2 Shaft Characteristics
3.2.8 Dual Feedback Control
4.3.3 Tool Spindle Temperature Characteristics
4.3.4 Installation of Tool Spindle Motor 6.4.2 Fuse Protection
4.4 Drive Unit 6.5 Noise Filter
4.4.1 Environmental Conditions 6.6 Surge Absorber
4.4.2 Heating Value 6.7 Relay
6.8 Selection of Link Connection
5 Dedicated Options
6.8.1 Connection of L11 and L21 Link
5.1 Servo Options
6.8.2 Connection of L+ and L- Link
5.1.1 Dynamic Brake Unit (MDS-D-DBU)
5.1.2 Battery Option (MDS-BAT6V1SET, MDSBTBOX- 7 Selection
LR2060) 7.1 Selection of the Servo Motor
5.1.3 Ball Screw Side Encoder (OSA405ET2AS, 7.1.1 Outline
OSA676ET2AS) 7.1.2 Selection of Servo Motor Capacity
5.1.4 Machine Side Encoder 7.1.3 Motor Shaft Conversion Load Torque
5.2 Spindle Options 7.1.4 Expressions for Load Inertia Calculation
5.2.1 Spindle Side ABZ Pulse Output Encoder (OSE- 7.2 Selection of the Spindle Motor
1024 Series) 7.3 Selection of the Power Supply Unit
5.2.2 Spindle Side PLG Serial Output Encoder 7.3.1 Calculation of Spindle Output
(TS5690, MU1606 Series) 7.3.2 Calculation of Servo Motor Output
5.2.3 Spindle Side Accuracy Serial Output Encoder 7.3.3 Selection of the Power Supply Unit
(Other Manufacturer's Product) 7.3.4 Required Capacity of Power Supply
5.3 Encoder Interface Unit 7.3.5 Example for Power Supply Unit and Power Sup-
5.3.1 Serial Output Interface Unit for ABZ Analog En- ply Facility Capacity
coder MDS-EX-HR 7.3.6 Selection of Regenerative Resistor for Power
5.3.2 Serial Signal Division Unit MDS-B-SD Backup Unit (R-UNIT-6,7) and
5.3.3 Pulse Output Interface Unit for ABZ Analog En- Capacitor Unit for Power Backup Unit (MDS-D/DH-
coder IBV Series CU)
(Other Manufacturer's Product)
8 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Specifications
5.3.4 Serial Output Interface Unit for ABZ Analog En-
8.1 Selection of Cable
coder EIB192M
8.1.1 Cable Wire and Assembly
(Other Manufacturer's Product)
8.2 Cable Connection Diagram
5.3.5 Serial Output Interface Unit for ABZ Analog En-
8.2.1 Battery Cable
coder EIB392M
8.2.2 Power Supply Communication Cable and Con-
(Other Manufacturer's Product)
nector
5.3.6 Serial Output Interface Unit for ABZ Analog En-
8.2.3 STO Cable
coder ADB-K70M
8.2.4 Servo Encoder Cable
(Other Manufacturer's Product)
8.2.5 Brake Cable and Connector
5.4 Drive Unit Option
8.2.6 Spindle Encoder Cable
5.4.1 DC Connection Bar
8.3 Main Circuit Cable Connection Diagram
5.4.2 Side Protection Cover
8.4 Connector Outline Dimension Drawings
5.4.3 Power Backup Unit (MDS-D/DH-PFU)
8.4.1 Connector for Drive Unit
5.4.4 Regenerative Resistors for Power Backup Unit
8.4.2 Connector for Servo
(R-UNIT-6,7)
8.4.3 Connector for Spindle
5.4.5 Capacitor Unit for Power Backup Unit (MDS-D/
8.4.4 Power Backup Unit Connector
DH-CU)
5.5 Cables and Connectors 9 Appx. 2: Restrictions for Lithium Batteries
5.5.1 Cable Connection Diagram 9.1 Restriction for Packing
5.5.2 List of Cables and Connectors 9.1.1 Target Products
5.5.3 Optical Communication Cable Specifications 9.1.2 Handling by User
6 Specifications of Peripheral Devices 9.1.3 Reference
9.2 Products Information Data Sheet (ER Battery)
6.1 Selection of Wire
9.3 Forbiddance of Transporting Lithium Battery by Pas-
6.1.1 Wire Selection Standards for Each Product
senger Aircraft Provided in the Code of Federal Regulation
6.1.2 Example of Wires by Unit
9.4 California Code of Regulation "Best Management Prac-
6.2 Selection of Circuit Protector and Contactor
tices for Perchlorate Materials"
6.2.1 Selection of Circuit Protector
9.5 Restriction Related to EU Battery Directive
6.2.2 Selection of Contactor
9.5.1 Important Notes
6.3 Selection of Earth Leakage Breaker
9.5.2 Information for End-user
6.4 Branch-circuit Protection (for Control Power Supply)
6.4.1 Circuit Protector
For outline dimension drawings, refer to "DRIVE SYSTEM DATA BOOK" (IB-1501252(ENG)).
Function Specifications List
MDS-EM/EMH-
Item MDS-E/EH-SP MDS-E-SP2 MDS-EJ-SP MDS-EJ-SP2
SPV3
1.1 Full closed loop control ● ● ● ● ●
1.5 Spindle's continuous position loop
● ● ● ● ●
control
1.6 Coil changeover control ● ● ● - -
1 1.7 Gear changeover control ● ● ● ● ●
Base
1.8 Orientation control ● ● ● ● ●
control
1.9 Indexing control ● ● ● ● ●
functions
1.10 Synchronous tapping control ● ● ● ● ●
1.11 Spindle synchronous control ● ● ● ● ●
1.12 Spindle/C axis control ● ● ● ● ●
1.13 Proximity switch orientation control ● ● (Note 1) ● ● ● (Note 1)
2.1 Torque limit function ● ● ● ● ●
2.2 Variable speed loop gain control ● ● ● ● ●
2.5 Disturbance torque observer ● ● ● ● ●
2.6 Smooth High Gain control (SHG
● ● ● ● ●
control)
2
2.7 High-speed synchronous tapping
Spindle ● ● ● ● ●
control (OMR-DD control)
control
2.8 Dual feedback control ● ● ● ● ●
functions
2.10 OMR-FF control ● ● ● ● ●
2.11 Control loop gain changeover ● ● ● ● ●
2.12 Spindle output stabilizing control ● ● ● ● ●
2.13 High-response spindle acceleration/
● ● ● ● ●
deceleration function
3.1 Jitter compensation ● ● ● ● ●
Variable Variable Variable Variable Variable
frequency: 4 frequency: 4 frequency: 4 frequency: 4 frequency: 4
3.2 Notch filter
Fixed Fixed Fixed Fixed Fixed
3 frequency: 1 frequency: 1 frequency: 1 frequency: 1 frequency: 1
Compensation
3.3 Adaptive tracking-type notch filter ● ● ● ● ●
control
3.4 Overshooting compensation ● ● ● ● ●
function
3.6 Lost motion compensation type 2 ● ● ● ● ●
3.8 Spindle motor temperature
● ● ● ● ●
compensation function
3.9 Real-time tuning I ● ● ● ● ●
4.1 Deceleration control at emergency stop ● ● ● ● ●
4.3 Earth fault detection ● ● ● ● ●
4.5 Fan stop detection ● ● ● ● ●
4
4.8 STO (Safe Torque Off) function ● ● ● (Note 2) ● ●
Protection
function 4.10 Deceleration and stop function at
● ● ● - -
power failure (Note 3)
4.11 Retraction function at power failure
● ● - - -
(Note 4)
5 5.4 Specified speed output ● ● ● - -
Sequence
5.5 Quick READY ON sequence ● ● ● - -
functions
6.1 Monitor output function ● ● ● ● ●
6.2 Machine resonance frequency display
6 ● ● ● ● ●
function
Diagnosis
6.3 Machine inertia display function ● ● ● ● ●
functions
6.4 Motor temperature display function ● ● ● ● ●
6.5 Load monitor output function ● ● ● ● ●
(Note 1) As for 2-axis spindle drive unit, setting is available only for one of the axes.
(Note 2) The dedicated wiring STO is not supported by MDS-EM/EMH Series.
(Note 3) The power backup unit and resistor unit option are required.
(Note 4) The power backup unit and capacitor unit option are required.
1
Installation
1 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
CAUTION
1. Do not hold the cables, axis or encoder when transporting the motor. Failure to observe this could lead to faults or
injuries.
2. Securely fix the motor to the machine. Insufficient fixing could lead to the motor deviating during operation. Failure to
observe this could lead to injuries.
3. When coupling to a servo motor shaft end, do not apply an impact by hammering, etc. The encoder could be damaged.
4. Never touch the rotary sections of the motor during operations. Install a cover, etc., on the shaft.
5. Do not apply a load exceeding the tolerable load onto the servo motor shaft. The shaft could break. Failure to observe
this could lead to injuries.
6. Do not connect or disconnect any of the connectors while the power is ON.
Environment Conditions
Ambient temperature 0°C to +40°C (with no freezing)
Ambient humidity 80% RH or less (with no dew condensation)
Storage temperature -15°C to +70°C (with no freezing)
Storage humidity 90% RH or less (with no dew condensation)
Indoors (no direct sunlight)
Atmosphere
No corrosive gas, inflammable gas, oil mist or dust
Operation / storage: 1000m or less above sea level
Altitude
Transportation: 10000m or less above sea level
IB-1501229-F 2
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
400V HG-H204, 354, 453, 703 24.5m/s2 (2.5G) or less 29.4m/s2 (3G) or less
series HG-H903
HQ-H903, 1103 9.8m/s2 (1G) or less 9.8m/s2 (1G) or less
HG-H1502 24.5m/s2 (2.5G) or less 24.5m/s2 (2.5G) or less
200
(double-sway width) (µm)
60
50 Y
X
40
30
20
Acceleration
3 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Nut
Washer
Pulley
CAUTION
Never hammer the end of the shaft during assembly.
Up
Down
IB-1501229-F 4
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Radial load
Thrust load
CAUTION
1. Use a flexible coupling when connecting with a ball screw, etc., and keep the shaft core deviation to below the tolerable
radial load of the shaft.
2. When directly installing the gear on the motor shaft, the radial load increases as the diameter of the gear decreases. This
should be carefully considered when designing the machine.
3. When directly installing the pulley on the motor shaft, carefully consider so that the radial load (double the tension)
generated from the timing belt tension is less than the values shown in the table above.
4. In machines where thrust loads such as a worm gear are applied, carefully consider providing separate bearings, etc., on
the machine side so that loads exceeding the tolerable thrust loads are not applied to the motor.
5. Do not apply the loads exceeding the tolerable level. Failure to observe this may lead to the axis or bearing damage.
5 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
c a
b
IB-1501229-F 6
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Degree of
No Torque
Backl Reliability freedom in Cautions in motor
Noise lubric Rigidity Life increased at
ash in coupling motor installation
ation deceleration
installation
Direct coupling
◯ Shaft core deviation
with ◯ ◯ ◯ ◯ ◯ × △
Looseness of bolt (In the case of single)
flexible coupling
Direct coupling
◯ Shaft core deviation
with ◯ ◯ ◯ ◯ ◯ × ×
Looseness of bolt Angle deviation
rigid coupling
△ Backlash too small
Gear × × △ △ △ ◯ ◯
Tooth chipping Pitch diameter too small
× Belt stretched too much
Timing belt △ ◯ ◯ × × ◯ ◯
Belt is broken Pitch diameter too small
CAUTION
If the cautions in motor installation in the above table are not observed, the motor will have a broken shaft, or the bearing
will have a shorter life. Carry out design and installation adjustment so that the load on the motor shaft will be below the
tolerable loads mentioned in "Shaft Characteristics".
(b) Less looseness produces less vibration and less noise at the coupling part.
On the other hand, if assembling is loose, lower rigidity may be caused. When using a coupling with lower
rigidity, the accuracy in centering the core doesn't have to be high, however, it is undesirable for servo. In order
to fully utilize the servo's efficiency to ensure the maximum durability of the equipments, it is required to use a
highly rigid coupling, and to fully align the shaft cores in the initial installation. It is also required to select the
optimum flexible coupling according to the working conditions, and use it correctly according to the
manufacturer's specification manual.
7 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Coupling
Load side
Motor side
0.01mm or less
Also note that the motor side ball screw bearing must be locked so that to avoid the thrust load on the motor shaft
due to expansion and contraction of the ball screw.
Load side
Oil or water
Servo motor
IB-1501229-F 8
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
(2) When a gear box is installed on the servo motor, make sure that the oil level height from the center of the shaft is higher
than the values given below. Open a breathing hole on the gear box so that the inner pressure does not rise.
Gear
Servo motor
Oil level
Lip
Oil seal
(3) When installing the servo motor horizontally, set the connector to face downward. When installing vertically or on an
inclination, provide a cable trap because the liquid such as oil or water may enter the motor from the connector by
running along the cable.
Cable trap
9 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
(4) Do not use the unit with the cable submerged in oil or water. (Refer to following drawing.)
Cover
Servo motor
Oil water
(5) Make sure that oil and water do not flow along the cable into the motor or encoder.
(Refer to following drawing.)
Cover
Servo motor
<Fault> Respiration
(6) When installing on the top of the shaft end, make sure that oil from the gear box, etc., does not enter the servo motor.
The servo motor does not have a waterproof structure.
Gear
Lubricating oil
Servo motor
CAUTION
1. The servo motors, including those having IP67 specifications, do not have a completely waterproof (oil-proof) structure.
Do not allow oil or water to constantly contact the motor, enter the motor, or accumulate on the motor. Oil can also enter
the motor through cutting chip accumulation, so be careful of this also.
2. Oil may enter the motor from the clearance between the cable and connector. Protect with silicon not to make the
clearance.
3. When the motor is installed facing upwards, take measures on the machine side so that gear oil, etc., does not flow onto
the motor shaft.
IB-1501229-F 10
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
The bending life of the encoder cable is as shown below. Regard this with a slight allowance. If the servo motor/spindle
motor is installed on a machine that moves, make the bending radius as large as possible.
8
11×x 108
7
55×x 107
7
22×x 107
7
11×x 107
6
55×x 106
No. of bends (times)
6
22×x 106
6
11×x 106
5
55×x 105
5
22×x 105
5
11×x 105
4
55×x 104
4
33×x 104
4 7 10
10 20
20 40 70 100
100 200
200
(Note) The values in this graph are calculated values and are not guaranteed.
11 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
CAUTION
1. Do not hold the cables, axis or encoder when transporting the motor. Failure to observe this could lead to faults or
injuries.
2. Securely fix the motor to the machine. Insufficient fixing could lead to the motor deviating during operation. Failure to
observe this could lead to injuries.
3. When coupling to a motor shaft end, do not apply an impact by hammering, etc. Failure to observe this could lead to
motor failures such as the shaft distortion or bearing/encoder damage.
4. Never touch the motor during operations or right after the stop. Install a cover, etc., on the rotary sections.
5. Do not apply a load exceeding the tolerable load onto the servo motor shaft. The shaft could break. Failure to observe
this could lead to injuries.
6. Do not connect or disconnect any of the connectors while the power is ON.
7. When coupling the motor directly with the spindle, perform the adequate centering and parallel correcting with the axis to
be coupled. The vibration of the motor should be 4.9m/s2 (0.5G) or less after balancing the spindle unit.
8. Perform a running-in before operating the machine.
Environment Conditions
Ambient temperature 0°C to +40°C (with no freezing)
Ambient humidity 90%RH or less (with no dew condensation)
Storage temperature -20°C to +65°C (with no freezing)
Storage humidity 90%RH or less (with no dew condensation)
Indoors (Where unit is not subject to direct sunlight)
Atmosphere
No corrosive gases, flammable gases, oil mist or dust
Operation/storage: 1000m or less above sea level
Altitude
Transportation: 10000m or less above sea level
Vibration X:29.4m/s2 (3G) Y:29.4m/s2 (3G)
IB-1501229-F 12
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
CAUTION
1. We consider key-less shaft as standard in order to simplify balancing procedure of such as gear, pulley, and coupling.
We recommend you to choose a gear, pulley and coupling that have a fully symmetric shape, and arrange screw holes
on their end faces at short and equal intervals in the circumferential direction.
2. Use a fastener such as a shaft lock element to fix those fittings to the motor shaft.
3. When you attach fittings to the motor shaft, be careful not to apply excessive impact by striking with a hammer, etc. This
may cause the shaft distortion and bearing damage.
4. When using screws for balancing, apply thread locker on the screws after balancing.
Measuring device
Coupling
Cushioning mat
Locations where motor vibration is measured
CAUTION
1. Make sure to place the motor on a cushioning mat to avoid resonance with surrounding devices during measurement.
2. Always secure the spindle motor body with a belt, etc. because it may roll due to the reaction torque generated during
acceleration/deceleration operation.
13 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Balancing
NO Vibration acceleration
ӌ0.5G(4.9m/s2 )
YES
Confirm the vibration in the motor rotation
speed range
NO Vibration acceleration
ӌ0.5G(4.9m/s2 )
YES
IB-1501229-F 14
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Radial load
CAUTION
Consider on the machine side so that the thrust loads are not applied to the spindle motor.
Frame No.
Measurement
Accuracy A71, B71, C71, A90, B90, A160, B160, C160,
point
C90,D90, E90, A112, B112 D160, A180, B180, A225
Run-out of the flange surface to the output shaft a 0.03mm 0.05mm
Run-out of the flange surface's fitting outer diameter b 0.02mm 0.04mm
Run-out of the output shaft end c 0.01mm 0.02mm
(Note) Refer to Specifications Manual for the frame number of each spindle motor.
c a
b
15 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
1.2.6 Installation of Rotary Joint and Coolant Joint (Hollow Shaft Specifications)
Attach the fittings such as pulley, gear, coupling, and coolant joint to the motor output shaft when connecting a spindle
motor to a spindle. The incorrect selection of fittings or inadequate installation accuracy can generate abnormal vibration
or noise at the coupling. It can also shorten the motor or bearing life, and can damage them (fretting or flaking). Contact
the manufacturer with any questions regarding the fittings mentioned above.
Spindle motor
Flaking:
Flaking occurs when small pieces of bearing raceway surfaces peel off due to rotation fatigue. It may occur in an early
stage due to an excessive load, handling fault, inadequate accuracy of shaft or housing, or a load application by incorrect
installation.
IB-1501229-F 16
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
17 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
ȭd
Coolant joint
A B
IB-1501229-F 18
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Motor shaft
Gap
Stop at the screw bottom
(3) Coupling
(a) Caution when selecting coupling
Always use a flexible coupling for coupling the spindle and the motor. The flexible coupling is flexible enough
to absorb a certain level of radial runout and parallel offset. The flexible coupling has tolerable values for three
degrees of freedom (parallel offset, angular misalignment, and axial movement), which realizes a low-vibration
and low-noise coupling up to high-speed rotation.
- Tolerable values of parallel offset and angular misalignment:
Absorbs minor misalignments or declinations that were not resolved during alignment.
- Tolerable value of axial movement:
Absorbs elongation of the spindle and motor shaft due to thermal expansion.
(These tolerable values are the standard values for which the coupling does not break. They are not the
standard values for which the load is not applied to the spindle or the motor bearing. Thus, in order to
rotate up to high-speed with low-vibration and low-noise, the spindle and the motor shaft must be
aligned.)
19 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
(i) Make sure that the pressure bolts of the coupling are loosened, and remove rust, dirt, and grease, etc.
from the shaft and the inner diameter part of the coupling. (Grease should be wiped away with a cloth,
etc., or by degreasing as required.)
(ii) When inserting the coupling into the motor shaft, make sure that no excessive force such as
compression, tension, etc. is applied to the element.
(iii) Make sure that the insertion length of the coupling into the motor shaft is kept in the position where the
target shaft is in contact with the entire length of the flange of the coupling (LF dimension) as illustrated
below. (For the variation of models and the length of LF of each model, contact the manufacturer.)
(iv) Tighten the pressure bolts lightly diagonally by using a bore for rotation prevention.
(v) Apply a dial gauge to the flange edge or outer diameter of the motor side. While rotating the motor shaft
lightly by hand, perform hammer adjustment on the flange periphery and edge so that the radial runout
will be reduced to as close as zero.
(vi) While performing hammer adjustment, tighten the pressure bolts in sequence. Finally, use a calibrated
torque wrench and tighten all the pressure bolts at the appropriate tightening torque as shown in the table
below. Also, refer to the following drawing for the sequence to tighten the pressure bolts, and make sure
that the bolts are tightened equally.
Pressure Tightening
bolt size torque (N•m)
M6 14
M8 34
(vii) Confirm that the pressure bolts of the motor shaft side are tightened to the specified torque and the value
of radial runout is small enough.
(viii) Install the motor mounted with coupling to the machine. At this time, adjust the motor mounting position
(inlay) while inserting the coupling into the spindle or feed screw. Check that there is no deformation of
the plate spring. Also check that the insertion length of the mating shaft is kept in the position where the
target shaft is in contact with the entire length of the flange of the coupling (LF dimension).
IB-1501229-F 20
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
(ix) The space between flange hubs (S) must be within the permissible error of the axial movement for the
standard value. Note that the allowable value assumes that parallel offset and angular misalignment are 0
(zero). Adjust them to achieve values as small as possible. (For the standard value of the S dimension of
each model, contact the manufacturer.)
(x) As in the sequence for the pressure bolts on the motor shaft side, sequentially tighten the pressure bolts
on the spindle side or the feed screw side. Finally, tighten the bolts at the appropriate tightening torque.
(xi) As a countermeasure against initial loosening of the pressure bolts, it is recommended to additionally
tighten the bolts with the appropriate tightening torque after a certain period of operation.
CAUTION
1. Select a coupling that the thrust load will not work on the motor shaft due to a rise of temperature, during cutting, or due
to the coolant pressure, etc.
2. Do not hit the coupling with a tool such as a hammer when installing it to the motor shaft so that the impact load will not
be applied to the bearing.
3. Do not rely on the flexibility of the coupling only. Make sure to perform alignment also. If the motor rotates with a parallel
offset, the bearing may be damaged by fretting wear etc. in a short amount of time.
4. When the motor shaft and the spindle are joined by a coupling, the motor shaft may stay pushed inside the motor.
Confirm that the distance from the surface to install the housing to support the rotary joint to the rear end of the flinger is
kept the same before and after inserting the coupling.
21 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
CAUTION
1. Rubber packing for waterproof is attached on the inner surface of the top cover of terminal block, and on the fan lead.
After checking that the packing is installed, install the top cover so that no foreign objects are stuck in between.
2. When installing a motor on a flange, chamfer(C1) the part of flange that touches inside low part of the motor.
Cooling fan
To yield good cooling performance, provide a space of at least 30mm
between the cooling fan and wall. If the motor is covered by a structure and
the air is not exchanged, its cooling performance degrades and the motor is wall
unable to fully exercise its performance, which may cause the spindle
motor overheat alarm. Do not use the spindle motor in an enclosed space
with little ventilation.
30mm or more
IB-1501229-F 22
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
1.2.9 Connection
(1) Cable wiring
When connecting the power line to the terminal block, tighten the screws with proper torque as shown below.
CAUTION
1. When connecting the power line to the terminal block, tighten the screws with proper torque described in this section.
2. Make sure to connect the terminal to the terminal block. If running the motor with the terminal loosened, fires could be
caused by motor overheat, and earth fault, short circuit and electric shocks could be caused by disconnection of the
terminal.
3.To keep the insulation distance, always cover crimp terminals with insulation tubes when connecting crimp terminals at
the end of the power line.
SJ-V/SJ-VL/SJ-PMF/SJ-4-V Series
SJ-D/DJ/DL/DG/DN Series
Outer diameter
23 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
[3] Screwdriver
[4]
[1]
[2]
CAUTION
1. Connection of a cable is restricted to one to one spring.
2. For connecting a cable, both twisted wire and solid wire can be used as it is without termination after the sheath has
been stripped. The cable attached with bar terminal can also be connected.
1.2.10 Cable
[1] Do not apply the bending stress and the stress from the cable's own weight on the cable connection part.
[2] Make sure that the cable sheathes will not be cut by sharp cutting chips, worn or stepped on by workers or vehicles.
[3] Provide a cable trap because the liquid such as oil or water may enter the motor from the connector by running
along the cable.
IB-1501229-F 24
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Environment Conditions
Ambient temperature 0°C to +40°C (with no freezing)
Ambient humidity 80% RH or less (with no dew condensation)
Storage temperature -15°C to +70°C (with no freezing)
Storage humidity 90% RH or less (with no dew condensation)
Indoors (no direct sunlight)
Atmosphere
No corrosive gas, inflammable gas, oil mist or dust
Operation/storage: 1000m or less above sea level
Altitude
Transportation: 10000m or less above sea level
Vibration X:19.6m/s2 (2G) Y:19.6m/s2 (2G)
Series Tool spindle motor Tolerable radial load Tolerable thrust load
HG46S, HG46K, HG56S, HG56K 245N (L=30) 98N
HG-JR73, 153 323N (L=40) 284N
HG96S, HG96K 392N (L=40) 147N
200V
HG75S, 105S 245N (L=33) 147N
series
HG54S, 104S, 154S, 224S 980N (L=55) 490N
HG204S, 354S, 453S, 703S 2058N (L=79) 980N
HG903S 2450N (L=85) 980N
400V
HG-JR734, 1534 323N (L=40) 284N
series
(Note 1) The tolerable radial load and thrust load in the above table are values applied when each motor is used
independently.
(Note 2) The symbol L in the table refers to the value of L below.
L
Radial load
Thrust load
25 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
CAUTION
1. Install the unit on noncombustible material. Direct installation on combustible material or near combustible materials may
lead to fires.
2. Follow the instructions in this manual and install the unit while allowing for the unit mass.
3. Do not get on top of the units or motor, or place heavy objects on the unit.
Failure to observe this could lead to injuries.
4. Always use the unit within the designated environment conditions.
5. Do not let conductive objects such as screws or metal chips, etc., or combustible materials such as oil enter the units.
6. Do not block the units intake and outtake ports. Doing so could lead to failure.
7. The units and servo motor are precision devices, so do not drop them or apply strong impacts to them.
8. Do not install or run units or servo motor that is damaged or missing parts.
9. When storing for a long time, please contact your dealer.
10. Always observe the installation directions. Failure to observe this could lead to faults.
11. Secure the specified distance between the units and panel, or between the units and other devices. Failure to observe
this could lead to faults.
Therefore, use the unit with the reduced effective load rate to 95% or less.
IB-1501229-F 26
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Installation clearance
10mm 10mm
or or
more more 260 Inlet
mm
Filter
60mm
CAUTION
1. The ambient temperature condition for the power supply unit or the drive units is 55°C or less.
2. Because heat can easily accumulate in the upper portion of the units, give sufficient consideration to heat dissipation
when designing the panel. If required, install a fan in the panel to agitate the heat in the upper portion of the units.
Filter
Filter
Cooling will be more high- Install a partition plate inside
efficiency by installing a partition to separate inlet and exhaust.
plate inside to separate inlet and
exhaust.
27 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
170
170
170
105
105
105
105
30 45 60 75
200
132
105
105
75 75
75 75
190
CAUTION
1. Design the inlet so that it is the position of the cooling fan.
2. Make the inlet and exhaust size more than the area that is a total of the cooling fan area.
IB-1501229-F 28
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
29 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
8
342
360
360
342
Square Square
hole hole
10
10
52 2-M5 screw hole 82
2-M5 screw hole
60
8
8
342
360
342
360
POINT
Attach packing around the square hole to provide a seal.
IB-1501229-F 30
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
[Unit: mm]
120 180
9
341
360
341
360
Square hole Square hole
10
10
222 282
POINT
Attach packing around the square hole to provide a seal.
31 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Power backup
Servo drive unit Spindle drive unit Power supply unit
unit
Heating value Heating value Heating value Heating value Heating value
Type [W] Type [W] Type [W] Type [W] Type [W] Type Heating
MDS- In- Out- MDS- In- Out- MDS- In- Out- MDS- In- Out- MDS- In- Out- MDS- value
E- side side E- side side E- side side E- side side E- side side D- [W]
panel panel panel panel panel panel panel panel panel panel
V1-20 18 22 V2-20 26 44 SP-20 24 31 SP2-20 28 62 CV-37 20 34 PFU 15
V1-40 20 38 V2-40 31 75 SP-40 29 65 SP2-40 38 130 CV-75 24 55
CV-
V1-80 25 71 V2-80 40 142 SP-80 37 121 SP2-80 54 242 25 99
110
V1- SP- SP2- CV-
36 148 V2-160 62 296 54 236 70 358 32 161
160 160 16080 185
V1- SP- CV-
44 201 V2-160W 77 403 78 404 45 272
160W 200 300
V1- SP- CV-
59 307 V3-20 60 71 100 520 53 343
320 240 370
V1- SP- CV-
72 399 V3-40 102 123 118 688 104 392
320W 320 450
SP- CV-
V3-80 139 111 148 897 164 431
400 550
SP-
196 1231
640
Power backup
Servo drive unit Spindle drive unit Power supply unit
unit
Type Heating value [W] Type Heating value [W] Type Heating value [W] Type Heating value [W] Type Heating
MDS- Inside Outside MDS- Inside Outside MDS- Inside Outside MDS- Inside Outside MDS- value
EH- panel panel EH- panel panel EH- panel panel EH- panel panel DH- [W]
V1-10 19 27 V2-10 28 54 SP-20 32 88 CV-37 20 34 PFU 15
V1-20 22 46 V2-20 33 93 SP-40 42 158 CV-75 24 55
V1-40 27 87 V2-40 45 173 SP-80 54 237 CV-110 25 99
V1-80 40 175 V2-80 70 350 SP-100 73 369 CV-185 32 161
V1-80W 47 222 V2-80W 83 445 SP-160 110 639 CV-300 45 272
V1-160 62 328 V2-160 111 656 SP-200 126 746 CV-370 53 343
V1-160W 81 461 V3-40 125 83 SP-320 168 1034 CV-450 104 392
V1-200 105 630 SP-480 232 1488 CV-550 164 431
SP-600 310 2039 CV-750 228 614
POINT
1. Design the panel's heating value taking the actual axis operation (load rate) into consideration.
2. The heating values in the above tables are calculated with the following load rates.
Unit
Load rate
IB-1501229-F 32
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
<Point>
Comparison of W>W1
[1] Refer to the section “ Heating Value” for the heat
W and W1
generated by each unit.
Consider heat
exchanger [2] Refer to the following calculation for calculation W1 of the
W҇W1
panel’s cooling capacity (thin steel plate).
W1 = U x A x T
2
U: 6W/m x °C (with internal agitating fan)
2
4W/m x °C (without internal agitating fan)
2
Manufacturing and evaluation A: Effective heat radiation area [m ]
㧔Heat dissipation area in panel㧕
Consider adding fan or Sections contacting other objects are excluded.
heat exchanger
T: Internal temperature rise value (10°C)
[3] Points in manufacturing and evaluation
T > 10͠ Understanding the temperature rise in the panel, and
Evaluate temperature
install a fan or heat exchanger.
in panel
T (average value) 10°C
T 10͠ Tmax (maximum value) 15°C
Completion
Flow of air
Relay, etc Relay, etc
Heat
exchanger
exchanger
Heat
Unit
Unit Flow of air
33 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
The following shows a calculation example for considering heat radiation countermeasures.
600
300
600
Heat radiation area (A): When a bottom section contacts with a machine
Heating value in panel (W): when installing four units which are 15W
W = 15 × 4 = 60 (W)
POINT
Measure an actual internal temperature, and install a fan or heat exchanger which agitates the heat at the top of the unit if
the temperature rise exceeds 10°C.
IB-1501229-F 34
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
40mm
40mm
POINT
The temperature of some units may rise locally, because air accumulates at a particular point. Therefore, take a
temperature measurement in each unit.
If a temperature at even one point exceeds 20°C in the temperature measurements, take a heat radiation countermeasure
such as addicting fans.
35 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
To maintain the encoder life and performance, a flexible coupling should be used to couple the spindle side encoder and
C-axis encoder with the spindle.
Encoder
0.02
Recommended coupling
Recommendation 1 Recommendation 2
Manufacturer Tokushu Seiko Eagle
Model Model M1 FCS38A
Resonance frequency 1374Hz 3515Hz
Position detection error 0.8×10-3 ° 1.2×10-3 °
Tolerable speed 20,000r/min 10,000r/min
Core deviation 0.7mm 0.16mm
Mis-alignment
Angle displacement 1.5° 1.5°
Max. length 74.5mm 33mm
Outline dimensions
Max. diameter Φ57mm Φ38mm
CAUTION
Confirm that the gear ratio (pulley ratio) of the spindle end to the encoder is 1:1.
IB-1501229-F 36
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
1.5.2 Spindle Side PLG Serial Output Encoder (TS5690, MU1606 Series)
[3] Keep the run-out of the outer diameter, when the detection gears are installed on the shaft, to 0.02mm or less.
[4] To remove a detection gear fixed with shrink fitting, use the screw holes opened in the axial direction for pulling
(two M5 screw holes or two M8 screw holes), or push the end with a jig. Carry out this work carefully. Applying
excessive force when pulling out the gears could cause the inner diameter of the detection gears to deform.
[5] Before reusing detection gears which have been removed, always measure the inner diameter dimensions,
and carefully check that the inner diameter is not deformed, and that the sufficient tightening amount can be
secured. Do not reuse the detection gears if the inner diameter is deformed, or if any abnormality such as
damage to the teeth is found.
37 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
sensor installation.
POINT
To install the sensor section, the notched fitting section on the machine side must have the specified dimensions.
The sensor's installation accuracy is assured by adjusting the outside dimensions of the notched fitting section.
3.0mm
Butt the back side of the sensor installation seat
39mm
against here
2-M4×0.8 screw
Butt the R section of the sensor installation seat
against here
Notched section's
outer diameter
IB-1501229-F 38
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
CAUTION
Do not operate the spindle before performing this installation accuracy diagnosis.
If operated with an improperly installed spindle side PLG encoder, the spindle motor may rotate at high speed.
Always perform this diagnosis before normal operation.
[1] Outline
In this section, check if the installation polarity of spindle side PLG encoder corresponds to the parameter setting,
and the gap between the gear and the sensor is appropriate. In a full-closed loop control where the encoder is also
installed on the spindle side, it is controlled based on the feedback of the spindle side encoder during the speed
command operation (S command). Do not command a normal spindle operation before confirming the installation
accuracy of the spindle side encoder.Spindle side PLG encoders (TS5690 Series) have the specified gap from the
gear by installing the sensor section on the machine-notched fitting section. Whether a signal is detected correctly
or not can be confirmed using the servo diagnosis screen on NC while rotating the spindle motor in an open loop
control.
1) Set the spindle parameter #13018/bit1 (SP018/bit1) to 1 to enable an open loop control.
2) Turn the NC and drive unit power OFF and disconnect the motor side encoder cable only. After that, turn
the power ON again.
3) Rotate the spindle by inputting 100r/min command. Although this is the same as normal S command
operation, neither the spindle side encoder feed back or the motor side encoder feed back is used for the
motor control on the spindle drive unit since the open loop control is set with the spindle parameter.
4) Switch to the [Servo diagn] menu on the NC maintenance screen and change from [Spindle unit] to [PLG
diagn]. When all the diagnosis signal bits are constantly at "0", the installation of PLG encoder is normal.
When the diagnosis signal bit is "1", the result of diagnosis is abnormal. Perform troubleshooting following
"[4] Diagnosis and remedy" by reference to the error details and main cause.
5) Set the spindle parameter #13018/bit1 (SP018/bit1) to 0 again and finish the open loop control after
stopping the spindle with stop command.
6) Turn the NC and spindle drive unit power OFF, and reconnect the motor side encoder cable as it was.
CAUTION
The spindle PLG diagnosis is only performed during the open loop control operation.Diagnosis screen is displayed even
during the normal operation, however, the error detection ("1" display) will not be performed.
39 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Item Details
Encoder Diagn L Display the motor end PLG diagnosis signal bit 7 to 0. *
Encoder Diagn H Display the motor end PLG diagnosis signal bit F to 8. *
Sub Encoder Diagn L Display the spindle side PLG diagnosis signal bit 7 to 0.
Sub Encoder Diagn H Display the spindle side PLG diagnosis signal bit F to 8.
* Used when adjusting a built-in motor.
1) Power ON
Open loop control enabled
2) Power ON again
5) Open loop control disabled
6) Power OFF
To CN3
Spindle
gear
TS5690 (Sensor)
Spindle
MU1606 (Gear)
TS5690 (Sensor)
IB-1501229-F 40
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Details of each diagnosis signal bit which is displayed as information for spindle PLG diagnosis are shown in the
following table.
Diagnosis
Error details Description Main factor
signal bit
0 A-phase amplitude excessive The A-phase amplitude is larger than the specified value. Too small gap
1 A-phase amplitude too small The A-phase amplitude is smaller than the specified value. Excessive gap
The deviation between the sensor
2 A-phase offset excessive + The A-phase offset is larger than the specified value to + side.
and the center of the gear
The deviation between the sensor
3 A-phase offset excessive - The A-phase offset is larger than the specified value to - side.
and the center of the gear
4 B-phase amplitude excessive The B-phase amplitude is larger than the specified value. Too small gap
5 B-phase amplitude too small The B-phase amplitude is smaller than the specified value. Excessive gap
The deviation between the sensor
6 B-phase offset excessive + The B-phase offset is larger than the specified value to + side.
and the center of the gear
The deviation between the sensor
7 B-phase offset excessive - The B-phase offset is larger than the specified value to - side.
and the center of the gear
8 Z-phase width excessive The Z-phase width is larger than the specified value. [AL2C factor] Too small gap
9 Z-phase width too small The Z-phase width is smaller than the specified value. Excessive gap
The relation of the phases between AB and Z is abnormal. The deviation between the sensor
A Z-phase error incorrect output
[AL2C factor] and the center of the gear
The relation of the phases between AB and Z is abnormal. The deviation between the sensor
B Z-phase error sliver waveform
[AL2C factor] and the center of the gear
C Z-phase error no signal The Z-phase signal is not detected. [AL2C factor] Excessive gap, detection gear error
D - - -
E Z-phase error logic reversed The Z-phase logic (normally positive) is reversed. [AL2C factor] Detection gear error
F - - -
CAUTION
1. When finely adjusting the sensor installation position, adjust after turning the power of the drive unit OFF.
2. "00000000" is also displayed in the following cases.
(1) When the spindle parameter #13018/bit1(SP018/bit1) is 0 (open loop disabled)
(2) When an encoder other than TS5690 Series is connected
41 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (Short-time rated %)
IB-1501229-F 42
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
Noise includes "propagation noise" generated from the power supply or relay, etc., and propagated along a cable
causing the power supply unit or drive unit to malfunction, and "radiated noise" propagated through air from a peripheral
device, etc., and causing the power supply unit or drive unit to malfunction.
Always implement these noise measures to prevent the peripheral devices and unit from malfunctioning. The measures
differ according to the noise propagation path, so refer to the following explanation and take appropriate measures.
43 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1 Installation
[5]
[7]
[7] [2]
[2]
[1]
Sensor
Instru- Drive
Receiver power
ment unit supply
[3] [6]
[4] [8]
Sensor
Servo motor
Spindle motor M
IB-1501229-F 44
2
Wiring and Connection
45 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
WARNING
1. Wiring work must be done by a qualified technician.
2. Wait at least 15 minutes after turning the power OFF and check the voltage with a tester, etc., before starting wiring.
Failure to observe this could lead to electric shocks.
3. Securely ground the drive units and servo/spindle motor.
4. Wire the drive units and servo/spindle motor after installation. Failure to observe this could lead to electric shocks.
5. Do not damage, apply forcible stress, place heavy items on the cables or get them caught. Failure to observe this could
lead to electric shocks.
6. Always insulate the power terminal connection section. Failure to observe this could lead to electric shocks.
CAUTION
1. Correctly and securely perform the wiring. Failure to do so could result in runaway of the servo/spindle motor or injury.
2. Do not mistake the terminal connections.
3. Do not mistake the polarity ( + , - ). Failure to observe this item could lead to ruptures or damage, etc.
4. Adjust the cable not to have an excess length. The excessive length could generate noise.
5. Do not mistake the direction of the diodes for the surge absorption installed on the DC relay for the motor brake and
contactor (magnetic contactor) control. The signal might not be output when a failure occurs.
Control output
Control output
signal signal
24G RA 24G RA
6. Electronic devices used near the drive units may receive magnetic obstruction. Reduce the effect of magnetic obstacles
by installing a noise filter, etc.
7. Do not install a phase advancing capacitor, surge absorber or radio noise filter on the power line (U, V, W) of the servo/
spindle motor.
8. Do not modify this unit.
9. If the connectors are connected incorrectly, faults could occur. Make sure that the connecting position and the
connection are correct.
10. When grounding the motor, connect to the protective grounding terminal on the drive units, and ground from the other
protective grounding terminal. (Use one-point grounding)
Do not separately ground the connected motor and drive unit as noise could be generated.
11. When the main grounding plate or the part to install a grounding cable is painted, remove the paint before grounding the
cable. The electrical connection becomes insufficient and noise could be generated.
IB-1501229-F 46
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
R L1 TE1 LV Spindle
MV Servo
motor motor
S L2 TE1 LW PLG MW Motor side
TE1 encoder
T L3
L+ TE2 L+
L+
TE2 TE2
MC MC1
L- L- L- LU
CN23
Ground (PE) MC2 Servo
LV
motor
L11 L11 TE3 L11
TE3 LW Motor side
TE3 encoder
L21 L21 L21
Circuit
protector
(Note 1) The total length of the optical communication cable from the NC must be within 30m and the specified bending
radius (for wiring inside panel: 25mm, and for wiring outside panel: 50mm) or more.
(Note 2) The connection method will differ according to the used motor.
(Note 3) Battery for the encoder back up is built-in the drive unit. (An external battery is available as an option.)
(Note 4) The main circuit ( ◎ ) and control circuit ( ○ ) and ground ( ● ) are safely separated.
(Note 5) Connect the ground of the motor to the ground of the connected drive unit.
47 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
CAUTION
1. Always use one AC reactor per power supply unit. Failure to observe this lead to unit damage.
2. When sharing a circuit protector for several power supply units, of a short-circuit fault occurs in a small capacity unit, the
circuit protector could trip. This can be hazardous, so do not share the circuit protector.
3. Be sure to use the circuit protector of proper capacity for each unit.
IB-1501229-F 48
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
CAUTION
Do not apply a voltage other than that specified in Instruction Manual on each terminal. Failure to observe this item could
lead to rupture or damage, etc.
Terminal
position
[2] [2]
[3] [3]
[1]
[4]
[4]
[1]
L1 L2 L3
L3
[1] TE1
L2 Compatible unit All of CV
L1 Screw size M5 x 12
Tightening torque 2.0Nm
49 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Terminal
position
[2]
[2] [2]
[3]
[3]
[4]
L1 L2 L3
[1] TE1 L1 L2 L3
Compatible E-CV 550 -
Compatible unit All of CV unit EH-CV - 550 to 750
Screw size M8 x 16 Screw size M10 x 20 M8 x 16
Tightening torque 6.0Nm Tightening torque 11.0Nm 6.0Nm
IB-1501229-F 50
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Terminal
position
[2] [2]
[3] [3]
[4] [1]
[1] [4]
LW
For L axis LV LU LV LW
LU
E-V1-
[1] TE1 320 320W
Compatible E-SP- 160 to 200 240 to 320
unit EH-V1- 160 to 160W -
EH-SP- 100 to 160 -
Screw size M5 x 12 M8 x 16
Tightening torque 2.0Nm 6.0Nm
(Note) This is a bottom view.
51 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
MDS-E-SP-400 to 640
Unit
MDS-EH-V1-200
Terminal
MDS-EH-SP-200 to 600
Terminal
position
[2]
[3]
[1] [4]
LU LV LW
POINT
Always install a large capacity drive unit in the left side of power supply unit, and connect with DC connection bar.
IB-1501229-F 52
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
MDS-E-V2-160W or less
Unit
MDS-E-SP2-80 or less MDS-E-SP2-16080
Terminal
MDS-EH-V2-160 or less
Terminal
position
[2]
[2]
[3] [3]
[4] [1]
[4]
[1]
LW
For L axis LV LU LV LW
LU Screw size
MW
M5 x 12
MW Tightening torque 2.0Nm
MV
For M axis MU
[1] TE1 MV
MU
E-V2- 20 to 160W
Compatible
L+ E-SP2- 20 to 16080
Terminal unit
[2] TE2 EH-V2- 10 to 160
specification/ L- Screw size M6 x 18
Pin
Tightening torque 4.0Nm
assignment
E-V2- 20 to 160W
Compatible
L11 E-SP2- 20 to 16080
unit
[3] TE3 L21 EH-V2- 10 to 160
Screw size M4 x 10
Tightening torque 1.2Nm
53 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Connector
position
[2] [2]
[3] [3]
[4] [4]
[1] [1]
LW LW
For L axis LV For L axis LV
LU LU
MW MW
For M axis MV
[1] TE1 For M axis MV
MU
MU
SW
SW For S axis SV
For S axis SV SU
SU
Terminal
(Note) This is bottom view. (Note) This is bottom view.
specification/
Pin
assignment Compatible unit All of V3
L+
[2] TE2 Screw size M6 x 18
L- Tightening torque 4.0Nm
IB-1501229-F 54
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Unit MDS-E-V1
MDS-EH-V1-200
Terminal MDS-EH-V1-160W or less
[1] CN1A
[2] CN1B
No.1
[3] CN5
No.5
Pin No.
[4] CN9
[5] CN4 No.20 No.10
No.11 No.1
Connector
specification
No.7 No.8
[6] CN8
No.1 No.2
No.9 No.1
[7] CN2L
[8] CN3L
No.10 No.2
Pin No.
55 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Unit
MDS-E/EH-V2
Terminal
[1] [3]
[2]
[4] [5]
[6]
[7]
[8] [11]
[9]
Connector [10]
position
[1] CN1A
[2] CN1B
No.1
[3] CN5
No.5
Pin No.
[4] CN9
[5] CN4 No.20 No.10
No.11 No.1
Connector
specification
No.7 No.8
[6] CN8
No.1 No.2
Pin No.
IB-1501229-F 56
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Unit
MDS-E/EH-V3
Terminal
[1] [3]
[2]
[4] [5]
[6]
[7]
[8] [13]
[9]
Connector [10]
[11]
position [12]
[1] CN1A
[2] CN1B
No.1
[3] CN5
No.5
Pin No.
[4] CN9
[5] CN4 No.20 No.10
No.11 No.1
Connector
specification
No.7 No.8
[6] CN8
No.1 No.2
[7] CN2L
[8] CN3L No.9 No.1
[9] CN2M
[10] CN3M
[11] CN2S No.10 No.2
[12] CN3S
Pin No.
57 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
[1] CN1A
[2] CN1B
No.1
[3] CN5
No.5
Pin No.
Connector [4] CN9
specification [5] CN4 No.20 No.10
No.11 No.1
No.7 No.8
[6] CN8
No.1 No.2
No.9 No.1
[7] CN2L
[8] CN3L
No.10 No.2
IB-1501229-F 58
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Unit
MDS-E-SP2-80 or less MDS-E-SP2-16080
Terminal
[1] CN1A
[2] CN1B
No.1
[3] CN5
No.5
Pin No.
Connector [4] CN9
specification [5] CN4 No.20 No.10
No.11 No.1
No.7 No.8
[6] CN8
No.1 No.2
59 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Drive unit
Connector for L axis (for 3-axis)
CNU01SEL
(For M axis)
Connector for M axis
CNU01SEM (For S axis)
Applicable cable
Insulator Strip length Connection
Axis name Connector model name Manufacturer
Size outer [mm] lever
dimension
L axis CNU01SEL (AWG14)
M axis CNU01SEM (AWG14)
AWG16 to 8 7.8mm or less 12mm J-FAT-OT-P J.S.T
S axis CNU01SES (AWG14)
Common CNU01SEF (AWG14)
POINT
The servo motor power supply connector is equipped with an anti-misinsertion mechanism, and can be connected only to
the power supply output of each certain axis. The connector without the anti-misinsertion mechanism (CNU01SEF
(AWG14)) can be connected to the power supply output of all axes.
(2) Power supply unit power supply connectors (Only for MDS-E-CV-37/75)
Power supply unit
(MDS-E-CV-37/75 only)
Connector for CV
CNU01SECV
Applicable cable
Insulator Strip length Connection
Axis name Connector model name Manufacturer
Size outer [mm] lever
dimension
For CV CNU01SECV (AWG14) AWG16 to 8 7.8mm or less 12mm J-FAT-OT-P J.S.T
IB-1501229-F 60
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Sheath
Core
Strip length
61 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
CAUTION
1. Connect the NC and the drive units by the optical communication cables. The distance between the NC and the final
drive unit must be within 30m and the specified bending radius (for wiring inside panel: 25mm, and for wiring outside
panel: 50mm) or more.
2. For the main circuit wiring of the drive unit and power supply unit, the drive unit of 200V series is to be wired with MDS-
D2-CV, and the drive unit of 400V series is to be wired with MDS-EH-CV.
POINT
Axis Nos. are determined by the rotary switch for setting the axis No. (Refer to section "Setting the rotary switch".) The axis
No. has no relation to the order for connecting to the NC.
Connected CN4
to the NC
Optical
communication CN4
Refer to the cable
instruction manual
of each NC for
details.
IB-1501229-F 62
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
(2) When using two or more power supply units within a single NC communication bus system
Two or more power supply units may be required within a single NC communication bus system if the spindle drive
unit capacity is large. The drive unit receiving power (L+, L-) from each power supply unit must always have NC
communication cable connection at the NC side of each power supply unit. In the NC communication bus
connection example below, power supply [1] cannot supply power (L+, L-) to the 5th axis servo drive unit.
For basic connection information, refer to "(1) When using one power supply unit".
Power
cannot be
supplied
Connections when using two power supply units within a single NC communication bus system
CAUTION
1. The drive unit receiving power (L+, L-) from each power supply unit must always have NC communication bus
connection at the NC side of each power supply unit.
2. If two or more power supply units are connected in the drive system, confirm that the units are not connected with each
other through the L+ and L- lines before turning ON the power. Also make sure that the total capacity of the drive units
connected to the same power supply unit meets the unit's selected capacity.
63 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
(3) When using the additional axis drive unit by supplying power (L+, L-) from MDS-EM/EMH unit
The power (L+, L-) can be supplied to the additional axis drive unit by using the power supply part which is built into
MDS-EM/EMH.
Optical
communication
cable
TE2
CAUTION
1. There is a limit to the combination of the drive unit.
Refer to "7.3 Selection of the Additional Axis Drive Unit" in MDS-EM/EMH Series Specifications Manual
(IB-1501238(ENG)).
2. When using the additional axis drive unit by supplying power (L+, L-) from MDS-EM/EMH unit, install the optical
communication cables in a manner that makes MDS-EM/EMH unit the final axis. Failure to observe this could lead to
damage unit.
3. When installing the additional axis unit, install the spindle drive unit with maximum capacity adjacent to the MDS-EM/
EMH-SPV3, and connections for other drive units should be such that the total TE2 wiring length is 800mm or less.
IB-1501229-F 64
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
1500mm or less
Large Small
Arrange drive units in order of nominal current from largest.
POINT
1. Arrange large capacity drive units at the left of the power supply unit with the clearance between the drive units being
1mm.
2. Power supply units equivalent to the number of large capacity drive units are required.
3. MDS-E-SP-400/640, MDS-EH-SP-200/320/480/600, and MDS-EH-V1-200 are the large capacity drive units.
65 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
MDS-E-V1
CN2L
No.10 No.2
Encoder connector
Max.10m Pin Name Pin Name
CMV1-R10P 1 P5(+5V) 2 LG
3 RQ 4 RQ*
3 2 1 5 6
7 6 5 4 7 SD 8 SD*
9 BT 10
10 9 8
Motor brake
magnetic wiring
Power connector : TE1
(Refer to section
Pin Name "Wiring of the motor
1 RQ magnetic brake" for 3:LW
2 RQ* details.) 2:LV Pin Name
1:LU
3 CNT 1 LU
4 BAT 2 LV
5 LG(GND) 3 LW
6 SD
7 SD*
8 P5(+5V)
9 LU LV LW (Note) This is a bottom view.
10 SHD
Optional cable: Power wire and grounding wire
MR-PWS1CBL (Refer to Specification manual for details
on selecting the wire.)
Power connector
JN4AT04NJ1-R
Pin Name
1
JN4AT02PJ1-R 2 U
3 V
3
1
Pin Name
4 W
1 B1
4
2 B2
2
IB-1501229-F 66
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
MDS-E/EH-V1
CN2L
No.10 No.2
Encoder connector
Max. 30m
Pin Name Pin Name
CMV1-R10P
1 P5(+5V) 2 LG
3 RQ 4 RQ*
3 2 1 5 6
7 SD 8 SD*
7 6 5 4
9 BT 10
10 9 8
Power connector : TE1
Motor magnetic
brake wiring
3:LW
Pin Name (Refer to section 2:LV Pin Name
1 RQ "Wiring of the motor 1:LU
1 LU
2 RQ* magnetic brake" for
2 LV
3 CNT details.)
4 BAT 3 LW
5 LG(GND)
6 SD
7 SD* (Note) This is a bottom view.
LU LV LW
8 P5(+5V)
9 Power wire and grounding wire
10 SHD (Refer to Specification manual for details
on selecting the wire.)
Power connector
CE05-2A18-10PD
Brake connector
CMV1-R2P D A Pin Name
A U
Pin Name
1 C B B V
1 B1
2 C W
2 B2
D Ground
These are 24VDC, and have
no polarity.
67 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
MDS-E/EH-V1
CN2L
No.10 No.2
Encoder connector
Max. 30m
Pin Name Pin Name
CMV1-R10P
1 P5(+5V) 2 LG
3 RQ 4 RQ*
3 2 1 5 6
7 SD 8 SD*
7 6 5 4
9 BT 10
10 9 8
Power connector : TE1
Motor magnetic
brake wiring
3:LW
Pin Name (Refer to section 2:LV Pin Name
1 RQ "Wiring of the motor 1:LU
1 LU
2 RQ* magnetic brake" for
2 LV
3 CNT details.)
4 BAT 3 LW
5 LG(GND)
6 SD
7 SD* (Note) This is a bottom view.
LU LV LW
8 P5(+5V)
9 Power wire and grounding wire
10 SHD (Refer to Specification manual for details
on selecting the wire.)
Power connector
CE05-2A22-22PD
Brake connector
CMV1-R2P D A Pin Name
A U
Pin Name
1 C B B V
1 B1
2 C W
2 B2
D Ground
These are 24VDC, and have
no polarity.
IB-1501229-F 68
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
MDS-E/EH-V1
CN2L
No.10 No.2
Encoder connector Max. 30m
Pin Name Pin Name
CMV1-R10P 1 P5(+5V) 2 LG
3 RQ 4 RQ*
5 6
3 2 1 7 SD 8 SD*
7 6 5 4 9 BT 10
10 9 8
Motor brake
magnetic wiring
(Refer to section
Pin Name
"Wiring of the motor
1 RQ magnetic brake" for
2 RQ* details.)
3 CNT
4 BAT Power wire and grounding wire
5 LG(GND) (Refer to Specification manual for details
LU LV LW on selecting the wire.)
6 SD
7 SD*
8 P5(+5V)
9 Power connector
10 SHD CE05-2A32-17PD
D A Pin Name
A U
Brake connector C B B V
CMV1-R2P C W
D Ground
Pin Name
1
1 B1
2
2 B2
These are 24VDC, and have
no polarity.
CAUTION
Dynamic brake unit is required for HP1103 and HP-H1103. Refer to section "Dynamic brake unit wiring" for details.
69 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
MDS-EH-V1-200
CN2L
No.10 No.2
3 2 1
Exhaust air
7 6 5 4
10 9 8
8 9 : %8 %9 %: 2+6 2+6
Thermal sensor
Pin Name terminal block
1 RQ Cooling air inlet (OHS1,OHS2) M4 screw
2 RQ*
3 CNT
Cooling fan terminal block
4 BAT
5 LG(GND) (BU,BV,BW) M4 screw
Motor power
6 SD terminal block
7 SD* Grounding terminal ( ) M6 screw
(U,V,W) M8 screw
8 P5(+5V)
9
10 SHD
CAUTION
1. For a 3-phase cooling fan, when the phase sequence of the 3-phase power supply is connected reversely, its cooling
capacity degrades due to the reversed rotation direction. Make sure the air blowoff direction.
When the fan rotates reversely, reconnect BU and BW reversely, and then check the blowoff direction.
2. The user must connect the motor thermal(OHS1 OHS2 maximum switching voltage 30V DC) with PLC and construct a
sequence in which an alarm occurs in an OPEN state.
3. Dynamic brake unit is required for HG-H1502. Refer to section "Dynamic brake unit wiring" for details.
IB-1501229-F 70
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
No.10 No.2
CNV2E cable Pin Name Pin Name
1 P5(+5V) 2 LG
Max. 30m
CN2L 3 RQ 4 RQ*
CNV2E cable 5 6
Ball screw side 7 SD 8 SD*
Max. 30m
encoder 9 BT 10
CN3L
Servomotor
(2) Connecting the linear scale (For Mitsubishi serial signal output)
Mitsubishi serial signal output (including when SIN wave signal output is converted to Mitsubishi serial signal output
with a scale manufacturer encoder interface unit) can directly connect to the drive unit.
No.10 No.2
Servomotor
71 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
(3) Connecting the linear scale (for rectangular wave signal output)
Rectangular wave signal output (including when SIN wave signal output is converted to the rectangular wave signal
output with a scale manufacturer encoder interface unit) can directly input to the drive unit.
No.10 No.2
Servomotor
Cable prepared by user
Linear scale
Max. 30m
( Rectangular wave signal output )
(4) Connecting the linear scale (for SIN wave signal output)
SIN wave signal output is converted to Mitsubishi serial signal output with the encoder interface unit (MDS-EX-HR).
The distance-coded reference scale interface is also available.
No.9 No.1
No.10 No.2
CNV2E-HP
cable
Max. 30m
Servomotor
Linear scale
( SIN wave signal output ) Cable
prepared MDS-EX-HR
by user Encoder conversion unit
IB-1501229-F 72
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
(1) Connecting SIN wave signal output linear scale (when using MDS-E/EH-V2)
For the FB signal of the linear scale, the SIN wave signal is converted to Mitsubishi serial signal with the encoder
conversion unit (MDS-EX-HR-11), and that signal is divided to each axis control inside the 2-axis drive unit.
MDS-E/EH-V2
CN2L
CNV2E cable
Max. 30m CN3L
CNV2E cable
Max. 30m
CN2M
Secondary axis
Primary axis
Linear scale
( SIN wave signal output )
CNV2E-HP
Cable cable
prepared MDS-EX-HR-11 Max. 30m
by user
Encoder conversion unit
Encoder type setting
Primary axis: SV025=A2xx
Secondary axis: SV025=D2xx
(2) Connecting Mitsubishi serial signal output linear scale (when using MDS-E/EH-V2)
The FB signal of the linear scale is divided to each axis control inside the 2-axis drive unit. An external option unit is
not required.
MDS-E/EH-V2
CN2L
CNV2E cable
Max. 30m
CNV2E cable CN3L
Max. 30m
CN2M
Secondary axis
Primary axis
73 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
(3) Connecting Mitsubishi serial signal output linear scale (when using two units of MDS-E/EH-V1)
The FB signal of the linear scale is divided to each drive unit with the signal division unit (MDS-B-SD).
MDS-E/EH-V1 MDS-E/EH-V1
(Primary axis) (Secondary axis)
CN2L CN2L
CNV2E cable
Max. 30m
CN3L
CN3L
IB-1501229-F 74
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
MDS-E/EH-SP
Encoder connector : CN2L
Pin No.
No.9 No.1
CN2L
Option cable: CNP2E-1 No.10 No.2
BU BV BW UVW
BUBVBW
W V U
Spindle motor
CAUTION
For a 3-phase cooling fan, when the phase sequence of the 3-phase power supply is connected reversely, its cooling
capacity degrades due to the reversed rotation direction. Make sure the air blowoff direction.
When the fan rotates reversely, reconnect BU and BW reversely, and then check the blowoff direction.
75 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
(2) Connecting the spindle side ABZ pulse output encoder (OSE-1024-3-15-68, OSE-1024-3-15-68-8)
MDS-E/EH-SP
Encoder connector:CN3L
Pin No.
No.9 No.1
CNP3EZ cable
Spindle max. 30m
(Note) Confirm that the gear ratio (pulley ratio) of the spindle end to the encoder is 1:1. Use a timing belt for
connecting.
(3) Connecting the spindle side PLG serial output encoder (TS5690)
MDS-E/EH-SP
Encoder connector:CN3L
Pin No.
No.9 No.1
CN2L
No.10 No.2
CNP2E-1 cable
max. 30m Pin Name Pin Name
1 P5(+5V) 2 LG
CN3L 3 RQ 4 RQ*
Spindle motor
5 6
7 SD 8 SD*
9 10
Spindle
Spindle side accuracy encoder
TS5690 series
CNP2E-1 cable
max. 30m
IB-1501229-F 76
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
CN2L
No.10 No.2
3 2 1
7 6 5 4
10 9 8
Pin Name
1 RQ Power wire and grounding wire
2 RQ* (Refer to Specification manual for details
3 CNT on selecting the wire.)
4 BAT LU LV LW
5 LG(GND)
6 SD
7 SD*
8 P5 (+5V)
9
10 SHD
Power connector
JN4AT04NJ1-R
Pin Name
1
1 Ground
2
2 U
3 V
3
4 W
4
(2) Connecting the HG75 / HG105 / HG54 / HG104 / HG154 / HG224 / HG-JR73-S105003 / HG-JR153-S105003 /
HG-JR734-S105003 / HG-JR1534-S105003
MDS-E-SP
Optional cable: CNV2E
(Refer to Appx.1 for details on the
cable treatment.)
Encoder connector : CN2L
Pin No.
No.9 No.1
CN2L
No.10 No.2
Max : 30m Pin Name Pin Name
1 P5(+5V) 2 LG
Encoder connector 3 RQ 4 RQ*
5 6
CMV1-R10P 7 SD 8 SD*
9 BT 10
3 2 1
7 6 5 4
10 9 8
Pin Name
1 RQ
2 RQ* Power wire and grounding wire
3 CNT (Refer to Specification manual for details
4 BAT on selecting the wire.)
5 LG(GND) LU LV LW
6 SD
7 SD*
8 P5 (+5V)
9
10 SHD
Power connector
CE05-2A18-10PD
D A Pin Name
A U
C B B V
C W
D Ground
77 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
No.10 No.2
Max : 30m
Pin Name Pin Name
1 P5(+5V) 2 LG
Encoder connector 3 RQ 4 RQ*
5 6
CMV1-R10P 7 SD 8 SD*
9 BT 10
3 2 1
7 6 5 4
10 9 8
Pin Name
1 RQ
2 RQ*
Power wire and grounding wire
3 CNT (Refer to Specification manual for details
4 BAT on selecting the wire.)
LU LV LW
5 LG(GND)
6 SD
7 SD*
8 P5 (+5V)
9
10 SHD Power connector
CE05-2A22-22PD
D A Pin Name
A U
C B B V
C W
D Ground
10 9 8
D A Pin Name
A U
C B B V
C W
D Ground
IB-1501229-F 78
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
3 2 1
7 6 5 4
10 9 8
D A Pin Name
A U
C B B V
C W
D Ground
CN2L
Encoder connector No.10 No.2
CMV1-R10P Pin Name Pin Name
Max : 30m 1 P5(+5V) 2 LG
3 2 1 3 RQ 4 RQ*
5 6
7 6 5 4 7 SD 8 SD*
9 BT 10
10 9 8
Pin Name
1 RQ
2 RQ*
3 CNT
4 BAT
5 LG(GND)
6 SD
7 SD* Power wire and grounding wire
8 P5 (+5V) (Refer to Specification manual for details
9 on selecting the wire.)
LU LV LW
10 SHD
Power connector
MS3102A14S-2P
D A Pin Name
A U
C B B V
C W
D Ground
79 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
CAUTION
1. Make sure that the power supply voltage is within the specified range of each unit. Failure to observe this could lead to
damage or faults.
2. For safety purposes, always install a circuit protector, and make sure that the circuit is cut off when an error occurs or
during inspections.
3. The wire size will differ according to each drive unit capacity.
4. For safety purposes, always install a magnetic contactor (contactor) on the main circuit power supply input. Large rush
currents will flow when the power is turned ON.
5. A semiconductor element is used in the power supply unit's magnetic contact drive circuit, and a surge absorber is
installed to protect the element. Therefore, a leakage current of approx. 15mA is passed. Confirm that the exciting coil in
the magnetic contact will not function at 15mA or less.
To NC
CN1A CN1A
CN1B
CN4 CN4
Circuit AC
reactor Contactor
protector
R L1
S L2 TE1
T L3
L+ L+ TE2 L+
TE2 TE2
MC MC1
Ground L- L- L-
CN23
MC2
: Control circuit
Ground Ground Ground
: Ground
CAUTION
1. The power supply unit is equipped with a power supply regenerative type converter; an AC reactor is surely installed in
the power supply line.
2. When connecting to the TE3 terminal, connect to the power supply side (primary side) of the AC reactor.
3. Connect the power supply unit's CN4 connector with the spindle drive unit of the maximum capacity. If there is no spindle
drive unit, connect to the servo drive unit which is the unbalance axis.
4. When installing the units dispersed install the spindle drive unit adjacent to the power supply unit, and connections for
other drive units should be such that the total TE2 wiring length is 1500mm or less.
IB-1501229-F 80
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
(2) When using two or more power supply units within a single NC communication bus system
Install a circuit protector and a contactor for each of the power supply units.
To NC
CN1A CN1A
CN1B CN1B
CN4 CN4
AC
Circuit reactor Contactor
protector
R L1
S L2 TE1
T L3
L+ L+ TE2 L+
MC MC1 TE2 TE2
Ground CN23 L- L- L-
MC2
TE3 TE3
L11 L11 L11
TE3
L21 L21 L21
Circuit
protector
CN1A CN1A
CN1B
CN4 CN4
Circuit AC
reactor Contactor
protector
5 L1
6 L2 TE1
7 L3
L+ L+ TE2 L+
TE2 TE2
MC MC1
Ground L- L- L-
CN23
MC2
TE3 TE3
L11 L11 L11
TE3
L21 L21 L21
Circuit
: Main circuit protector
: Control circuit
Ground Ground Ground
: Ground
CAUTION
1. An AC reactor and circuit protector are required for each power supply unit.
2. Install the spindle drive unit of large capacity adjacent to the power supply unit, and connections for other drive units
should be such that the total TE2 wiring length is 1500mm or less.
3. Make sure that the total capacity of the drive units connected to the same power supply unit meets the unit's selected
capacity and connect the CN4 of the drive unit, which is used as a final axis (when a spindle drive unit is included,
spindle drive unit), with that of the power supply unit.
4.Confirm that the power supply units are not connected with each other through the TE2(L+,L-) wiring before turning the
power ON.
81 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
D/DH-AL
Grounding plate
Servo motor
Spindle motor
POINT
Do not connect the grounding cable from each unit directly to the grounding plate. Noise from other units could result in
malfunctions.
Unit
Grounding
plate
IB-1501229-F 82
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
CN20
1A : P24
2A : DBR
3A : MBR1
Brake
3B : MBR2
1B : 24G
24G
CAUTION
1. CN20 connector and the brake can be connected directly because the servo drive unit contains the surge absorber.
2. The brakes cannot be released just by connecting motor brake terminal. 24VDC must be supplied.
3. For the 24V power supply used in the motor brake circuit, use the one separated from the 24V power supply for the
control circuit.
4. Only one axis can be controlled by the motor brake with CN20. The maximum brake tolerable current value of the CN20
is 1.7A.
83 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
MDS-E/EH-V3
CN9
L-axis M-axis S-axis
8 : SBC1
brake brake brake
10: DOCOM
CAUTION
When using SBC (Safe Brake Control) function, the CN9 connector is dedicated to the M axis and the motor brakes cannot
be connected in parallel.
Refer to "3.3 SBC (Safe Brake Control)" for details.
PLC axis
Motor brake control
The brake does
not work.
Servo OFF command
Servo ON
command
Danger !
NC axis
Axis drop
IB-1501229-F 84
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
ON
Servo ready signal (RDY) OFF Ready completion
Servo ready completion ON
OFF Command input enable
signal (SA)
85 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
POINT
Using the high-speed ready ON sequence, set the parameter for all the axes including the spindle. Especially when it is not
set for the power supply control axis, power supply will not work at high-speed sequence.
CAUTION
When SV017/bit2=1, SP017/bit2=1 is set, for the model using an external dynamic brake, the Ready completion will be
delayed by 10ms to ensure the external contactor operation time.
200ms
SERVO ON
Servo OFF command
SERVO OFF
OFF
Dynamic brake
ON
ON
Motor ON (GATE)
OFF
CAUTION
1. The vertical axis drop prevention control only is performed during an emergency stop (including alarms and power
failures). It is not performed when a servo OFF command is input.
2. To operate the motor brake control output (MBR) of the 2-axis or 3-axis drive unit, input the servo OFF command to all
the servo axes in the unit.
IB-1501229-F 86
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
External
power supply
2B 2A 3B : MBR2
(N.C.) (DBR) 1B : 24G
Control terminal
1B 1A block (M3)
(24G) (P24)
Terminal Name
Twist wire 1
2 NC
3 a
4 b
5 13
6 14
U V W a b
Power terminal
block (M3)
Terminal Name
1 U
2 V
3 W
Servomotor
W
U
R (0.5 )
14
13
MC SK
CAUTION
Correct wire the dynamic brake unit to the servo drive unit.
Do not use for applications other than emergencies (normal braking, etc.). The internal resistor could heat up, and lead to
fires or faults.
POINT
When you use a servo motor with a brake, please wire (between 3A pin and 3B pin) of CN20 connector.
87 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
For a switch or relay to be wired, use a switch or relay that satisfies the input/output (voltage, current) conditions.
IB-1501229-F 88
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
24V 24V
DI1 13 4.1k
Relay, etc.
8 MPO1
D01
18 MPO2
4.1k D02
DI2 2
16 MPO3
D03
7 MPO4
D04
DI3 3 4.1k
12 MPO5
D05
10 24G
DI4 14 4.1k
(2)
(2)
Servo/spindle
drive unit
DI5 17 4.1k
4A
(1) Power supply unit
89 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
CAUTION
The different signal changeover parameter setting is not available for the same connector pin number of each axis in 2-axis
or 3-axis drive unit.
IB-1501229-F 90
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Speed command
0 [mm/min] 0 [mm/min]
Machine end speed
Output signal
ON OFF ON
L-axis
0 [mm/min] 0 [mm/min]
㻌
M-axis
Specified speed [mm/min]
0 [mm/min] 0 [mm/min]
㻌
Output signal ON OFF ON
As for 2- axis drive unit, the output signal turns OFF when either axis exceeds the
specified speed, and it turns ON when both axes are within the specified speed.
L-axis
0 [mm/min] 0 [mm/min]
M-axis
0 [mm/min] 0 [mm/min]
㻌
S-axis
Specified speed [mm/min]
0 [mm/min] 0 [mm/min]
As for 3- axis drive unit, the output signal turns OFF when one of the axes exceed
the specified speed, and it turns ON when all axes are within the specified speed.
91 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
0: mm/min 1: 100mm/min
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (mm/min)
However, when SV033/bitD=1, the setting range is from 0 to 32767(100mm/min).
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (r/min)
IB-1501229-F 92
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
6000
4000
Spindle motor speed
SP028
(r/min)
2000
(SP028+SP029)
0
Time
Speed detection (SD1) [SP → NC]
L coil selection command (LCS) [NC → SP]
Changing coil (MKC) [SP → NC]
---Setting range---
10 to 32767 (r/min)
---Setting range---
10 to 1000 (r/min)
93 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
---Setting range---
0 to 3500 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 3500 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (Short-time rated %)
IB-1501229-F 94
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
(3) Wiring
The illustration below shows the 2 types of changeover that occur after a coil changeover, (a) (star) - Δ(delta)
changeover, and (b) (star)- (star) changeover. As shown in (c), one of the contactors (MC1 or MC2) is turned
ON and the other is turned OFF at all of the coil changeover control circuits.
Motor terminal
U U
V V
W W
MC2
Spindle
drive unit
MC1 X
Y
Z
Spindle motor
Coil changeover circuit
U U U U Z
V V
W W
Spindle Spindle
drive unit drive unit
X
Y Z
X W
V W V Y
POINT
Wire it according to each 6 terminal’s sign (U, V, W, X, Y, Z) of spindle motor for the coil changeover.
95 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Motor terminal
U MC1 U1
V V1
W W1
Spindle MC2 U2
drive unit
V2
W2
U U1 U U1
V V
W W
Spindle Spindle
drive unit drive unit
U2 U2
V2 W2 V2 W2
V1 W1 V1 W1
POINT
Wire it according to each 6 terminal’s sign (U1, V1, W1, U2, V2, W2) of spindle motor for the coil changeover.
MDS-E/EH Series
RA RA
(make contact) (break contact)
IB-1501229-F 96
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Item Specification
Output method DC double wire system /three wire system
Power supply voltage 24V DC
Response frequency 400Hz or more
Load current 14mA or more
Residual voltage 4V or less
Leakage current 1mA or less
MDS-E/EH-SP
Proximity switch
Shield
CN9
20 DICOM
13 DI1
4.1k
24VDC Detection circuit
Current direction
Case
ground
< Connection details: For proximity switch of three wire system >
MDS-E/EH-SP
Proximity switch
Shield
CN9
20 DICOM
13 DI1
4.1k
24VDC Detection circuit
Current direction
Case
ground
MDS-E/EH-SP
24VDC
Proximity switch
Shield
CN9
20 DICOM
13 DI1
4.1k
Detection circuit
Current direction
Case
ground 24G
< Connection details: For proximity switch of three wire system >
Not usable.
CAUTION
1. Supply the 24VDC power externally.
2. Install a proximity switch at the spot that rotates in the ratio of 1:1 to the spindle.
3. Set the spindle parameter to the pulley ratio for belt drive or to the gear ratio for gear drive.
97 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
Enable edge
Enable Drive unit input signal polarity
Sensor operation selection
detection (CN9 DI1)
(SP225/bit5)
Normal open
Rising part
(NO) Detection of enable
Falling edge
Normal close (0)
Falling part
(NC)
Normal open
Rising part Detection of enable
(NO)
Rising edge
Normal close (1)
Falling part
(NC)
IB-1501229-F 98
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
---Setting range---
-35999 to 35999 (0.01°)
(Note) When spindle zero point return proximity switch detection is enabled, the rotation direction of
the orientation/zero point return (synchronous tapping, spindle/C axis, etc.) will follow Z phase
detection direction. And the speed will follow Z phase detection speed (In order to prevent the
influences of the delayed detection of the signal pulse edges).
99 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
2 Wiring and Connection
IB-1501229-F 100
3
Safety Function
101 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
3 Safety Function
WARNING
Precautions for the safety function described in this manual are as follows.
Read carefully all the following fundamental precautions for safety to prevent human injury or property damage.
1. Only a qualified person is authorized to perform the installation, start, repair, or adjustment of the device in which these
equipment are installed.
2. The qualified person must be familiar with the laws of the country where the device into which this product is built is
installed, especially the standards described in this book, and the requirements which are listed in EN ISO 13849-1,IEC/
EN 61508,IEC 61,800-5-2 and IEC 60,204-1.
3. To perform the start, programming, setting and maintenance of the device in accordance with the safety standards, the
staff who undertakes these work should obtain permission from the company it belongs to.
IB-1501229-F 102
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
3 Safety Function
CAUTION
Device manufacturer accepts responsibility for all the risk assessments and related residual risks. The followings are the
residual risks relevant to the STO function. Mitsubishi Electric will not accept liability for any accidents such as damage or
injury caused by such residual risks.
1. STO function is a function to remove the energy of the motor electronically and not the function to shut off the input
power to the drive unit or the connection between the drive unit and the motor physically. Therefore, the risk for electric
shocks cannot be eliminated with the STO function. To prevent electric shocks, use the EMG function.
2. STO function is a function to disable the energy to the motor electronically. It does not guarantee the shutoff or the
procedure for the deceleration control of the motor.
Read carefully the manual of each safety-related device for the correct installation, wiring, and adjustment.
For all the safety-related relay, sensor, etc., use the one which satisfies the safety standards. TUV SUD has confirmed
that the safety-related parts by Mitsubishi Electric described in this manual satisfy EN ISO13849-1 Category 3, PL d.
3. Even though the STO function is enabled by the STO switch, voltage may still be residual at the servo motor for the delay
specific to the device.
4. Safety is not guaranteed until the installation or adjustment for the safety-related parts in the system has been
completed.
5. When replacing the drive unit, make sure that the new product is the same as the one before the replacement. After the
installation, be sure to confirm the performance of the safety function before operating the system.
6. Perform all the risk assessments and safety level certifications for the whole device and system. The use of a third-party
certifier such as TUV SUD is recommended as a final safety certification of the system.
7. To prevent the accumulation of failure, perform an appropriate safety confirmation check at regular intervals as required
by the safety standards. The safety confirmation check must be performed at least once a day regardless of the safety
level of the system.
8. When up-and-down short circuit is occurred to the power module of the drive unit, the servo motor shaft rotates for up to
0.5 revolution.
9. Be sure to supply the STO input signal (STO1, STO2) from one power supply. If the power is divided, STO shutoff state
may not be realized due to a malfunction of the STO function caused by a sneak current.
DANGER
Improper installation of a safety-related device or a system could cause a operation state without safety guaranteed and
may lead to a serious or fatal accident.
Preventive measure against the above danger
As described in IEC 61800-5-2, the STO (Safe Torque Off) function is a function not to supply a energy from a drive unit to
a motor and does not guarantee that a motor is not moved by an external force and other influence.
Take safety measure such as brake or counter balance additionally when the external force is acted on by the motor itself.
103 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
3 Safety Function
Safe Torque Off function is a shutoff function which does not provide the energy to the motor capable of generating
torque and it shuts off an energy supply electronically inside the drive unit.
STO function can be used in the following two ways ((1) and (2) below).
< A system configuration example when using network STO function >
Safety I/O unit NC Drive unit Power supply
unit
Emergency Optical
stop input communication
Power shutoff
CAUTION
This function is set with the NC. Refer to the smart safety observation function for details of the setup and control method.
IB-1501229-F 104
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
3 Safety Function
< A system configuration example when using dedicated wiring STO function >
Optical communication
MDS-E/EH
CNC Series
(2) STO signal is input
from the CN8 connector
CN8
Connector for dedicated wiring STO signal (CN8) and signal array
IO unit
for NC controller CN8
Connector for dedicated wiring
TOF1 STO input/output signal (CN8)
TOF2 7 8
TOF2 TOF_COM
5 6
STO2 TOF1
3 4
STO_COM STO1
1 2
105 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
3 Safety Function
< Operation sequences example for dedicated wiring STO function >
STO1 signal
STO signal
switching
timing
CAUTION
1. Do not connect a cable to pin 1 and 2 of CN8. A malfunction or failure may result.
2. Input the STO signal during servo OFF.
POINT
1. For this function which inputs the STO signal directly to the drive unit, safety is ensured by inputting synonymous STO
signals redundantly to shut off the energy supply with the independent control.
2. Diagnosis for the input status of STO signal can be performed by using TOF signal.
IB-1501229-F 106
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
3 Safety Function
STO1 4 8 TOF_COM
STO2 5 6 TOF1
STO_COM 3 7 TOF2
STO_COM
4kΩ
Switch
STO1/STO2
24VDC ± 10%
200mA
Drive unit
The drive unit is
1 Insulation method Insulation
damaged when the 2 Rated load voltage 24V
Load polarity is reversed. 3 Rated current 40mA or less
TOF1/TOF2
4 Maximum current 50mA or less
TOF_COM 5 Rush current 100mA or less
(Note) 24VDC±10% 6 Internal voltage drop 1.3V or less
CAUTION
Maximum 1.3V of voltage drop occurs inside the drive unit. Select an external connection device operable in the output
voltage after the voltage drop.
107 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
3 Safety Function
IB-1501229-F 108
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
3 Safety Function
Crosscheck
Motor brake
Safety
observation Circuit information SBC circuit
Brake signal
109 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
3 Safety Function
[1] Motor brake control connector (CN20) output circuit (When using the brake of L axis)
As shown in the illustration below, an external power supply circuit is controlled by the CN20 connector output.
Dynamic brake unit is controlled simultaneously for the servo drive unit with the capacity of MDS-E-V1-320W
or larger and MDS-EH-V1-160W or larger. Refer to "Dynamic brake unit wiring" for details.
External 24VDC power supply
MDS-E/EH-V1/V2/V3
CN20
1A : P24
2A : DBR
3A : MBR1
Brake
3B : MBR2
1B : 24G
24G
[2] Motor brake control connector (CN9) output circuit (When using the brake of M axis)
As shown in the illustration below, the brake control is enabled by using DO output of CN9 for an external
power supply circuit.
Be careful not to mistake the polarity. The drive
unit is damaged when the polarity is reversed.
MDS-E/EH-V1/V2/V3
CN9
8 : SBC1 External 24VDC
10 : DOCOM Brake power supply
16 : SBC2
Always install a
surge absorber.
* The brake control command for M-axis side motor is output from CN9 (8pin-16pin) connector.
CAUTION
1. For SBC, the brake control of the CN20 connector is dedicated to the L axis and the brake control of the CN9 connector
is dedicated to the M axis.
2. The maximum brake tolerable current value of CN20 is 1.7A.
3. The brakes cannot be released just by connecting motor brake terminal. 24VDC must be supplied.
4. For the 24V power supply used in the motor brake circuit, use the one separated from the 24V power supply for the
control circuit.
IB-1501229-F 110
4
Setup
111 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 112
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
MDS-E/EH-CV setting
CAUTION
An axis set unused is not included in the functional safety.
113 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
Initializing completed
Executing initial Contactor OFF
communication with NC Ready OFF state
In ready ON
(In Charging)
Contactor ON
CAUTION
1. Always input emergency stop when starting the servo system.
2. Do not insert or extract the external STO input connector (CN8) after starting the servo system. Motor power will be shut
off and it may cause the collision of machine.
IB-1501229-F 114
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
4.2 Setting the Initial Parameters for the Servo Drive Unit
The servo parameters must be set before the servo system can be started up. The servo parameters are input from the
NC. The input method differs according to the NC being used, so refer to each NC Instruction Manual.
When setting the initial setting parameters, perform the following settings in each system.
<For full closed loop control with a distance-coded reference scale (single-axis control)>
(1) Set the standard parameters in the section "4.2.5 List of Standard Parameters for Each Servo Motor".
(2) "4.2.1 Setting of Servo Specification Parameters"
(3) "4.2.2 Setting of Machine Side Encoder"
(4) "4.2.3 Setting of Distance-coded Reference Scale"
Setting the initial parameters above enables the test operation for the servo axis (Ex. manual pulse feed, low-speed JOG
feed). When machine resonance occurs, check the machine resonance frequency at AFLT frequency on the drive
monitor screen and set to the following servo parameters (When the AFLT frequency displays "0", resonance is not
occurring).
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (Hz)
115 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 116
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
When the emergency stop input signal of the power supply unit is "enabled"
(Note) Set the power supply rotary switch to "4".
Power supply unit is not connected : 0000h
MDS-E-CV-37 / MDS-EH-CV-37 : 0044h
MDS-E-CV-75 / MDS-EH-CV-75 : 0048h
MDS-E-CV-110 / MDS-EH-CV-110 : 0051h
MDS-E-CV-185 / MDS-EH-CV-185 : 0059h
MDS-E-CV-300 / MDS-EH-CV-300 : 0070h
MDS-E-CV-370 / MDS-EH-CV-370 : 0077h
MDS-E-CV-450 / MDS-EH-CV-450 : 0085h
MDS-E-CV-550 / MDS-EH-CV-550 : 0095h
MDS-EH-CV-750 : 00B5h
bit 8 : nohis History of communication error alarm between NC and DRV (34, 36, 38, 39)
0: Enable 1: Disable
117 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
Note that the value must be input in increments of 10K pulses (the 1st digit of the setting value is
"0").
If any restriction is imposed due to the above condition, also set SV117 in one pulse increments.
SV117= Quotient of the number of pulses divided by 65536 (If the quotient is 0, set SV117 to -1).
SV019= Remainder of the number of pulses divided by 65536
(SV019 can be set in one pulse increments).
IB-1501229-F 118
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
119 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 120
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (μm)
121 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (mm)
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (μm)
Base reference mark interval [mm] Auxiliary reference mark interval [μm]
Manufacturer Series
(SV130) (SV131)
LF 20 4
HEIDENHAIN
LS 20 20
CORPORATION
LB 80 40
S, M, C and G 20 20
FAGOR F 100 100
L 80 40
Renishaw RSLM 80 20
IB-1501229-F 122
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
【#2335】 SV135 RPn0H Distance-coded reference check /position within one rotation High
【#2336】 SV136 RPn0L Distance-coded reference check / position within one rotation Low
Set this parameter to operate distance-coded reference check when using distance-coded reference
scale.
During the distance-coded reference check initial setup (SV137:RAER=-1), set the following items
on the NC drive monitor screen after the distance-coded reference check initial setup warning A3
turns OFF.
---Setting range---
-1 to 32767 (mm)
123 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
CAUTION
1. When performing the speed command synchronous control with 2-axis drive unit (MDS-E/EH-V2), make sure to set L-
axis as primary axis. When performing the speed command synchronous control with 3-axis drive unit (MDS-E-V3),
make sure to set L-axis as primary axis and M-axis as secondary axis.
2. The rectangular waveform output scale is not available for the speed command synchronous control.
3. The distance-coded reference scale is not available for the speed command synchronous control.
4. When using speed command synchronization control, the following setting of NC side is required.
- Set bit3 of #1281:ext17 to "0" and disable the synchronous error automatic correction function at servo ON.
- Set #1064:svof of the primary axis and secondary axis to "0" and disable the error correction at servo OFF for both
axes.
- The parameter settings related to the machine error compensation such as quadrant protrusion compensation must be
the same for the primary axis and secondary axis.
IB-1501229-F 124
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
125 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 126
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
127 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 128
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
129 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 130
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
When using the OMR-FF control, set the servo rigidity against quadrant projection or cutting load, etc. For
the tracking ability to the command, set by SV106(PGM).
---Setting range---
1 to 200 (rad/s)
#2204 SV004 PGN2 Position loop gain 2
When performing the SHG control, set the value of "SV003 x 8/3" to "SV004".
When not using the SHG control, set to "0".
When using the OMR-FF control, set to "0".
131 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
Gain
VGN1
VGN2
Speed
0 VCS VLMT
(Overspeed detection speed)
---Setting range---
-1000 to 30000
#2207 SV007 VIL Speed loop delay compensation
Set this when the limit cycle occurs in the full-closed loop, or overshooting occurs in positioning. The speed
loop delay compensation method can be selected with SV027/bit1,0.
Normally, use "Changeover type 2". Changeover type 2 controls the occurrence of overshooting by lowering
the speed loop lead compensation after the position droop gets 0.
When setting this parameter, make sure to set the torque offset (SV032).
---Setting range---
0 to 32767
#2208 SV008 VIA Speed loop lead compensation
Set the gain of the speed loop integral control.
Standard setting: 1364
Standard setting in the SHG control: 1900
Adjust the value by increasing/decreasing this by about 100 at a time.
Raise this value to improve contour tracking accuracy in high-speed cutting.
Lower this value when the position droop does not stabilize (when the vibration of 10 to 20Hz occurs).
---Setting range---
1 to 9999
#2209 SV009 IQA Current loop q axis lead compensation
Set the fixed value of each motor.
Set the standard value for each motor described in the standard parameter list.
---Setting range---
1 to 20480
#2210 SV010 IDA Current loop d axis lead compensation
Set the fixed value of each motor.
Set the standard value for each motor described in the standard parameter list.
---Setting range---
1 to 20480
#2211 SV011 IQG Current loop q axis gain
Set the fixed value of each motor.
Set the standard value for each motor described in the standard parameter list.
---Setting range---
1 to 8192
IB-1501229-F 132
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
133 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
mdir
dfbx
vfb
sdir
abs
mp
drvup
spm
IB-1501229-F 134
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
For 1000 pulse unit resolution encoder, set the number of pulses in SV019 in increments of 1000 pulse (kp).
The value must be input in increments of 10K pulses (the 1st digit of the setting value is "0").
In this case, make sure to set "0" to SV117.
For high-accuracy binary resolution encoder, set the number of pulses to four bite data of SV117 (high-order)
and SV019 (low-order) in pulse (p) unit.
SV117 = number of pulses / 65536 (when =0, set "-1" to SV117)
SV019 = the remainder of number of "pulses / 65536"
---Setting range---
When SV117 = 0, the setting range is from 0 to 32767 (kp)
When SV117≠0, the setting range is from 0 to 65535 (p)
(PR) #2220 SV020 RNG2 Main side encoder resolution
Normally, set to "0".
For 1000 pulse unit resolution encoder, set the number of pulses to SV020 in increments of 1000 pulse(kp).
The value must be input in increments of 10K pulses (the 1st digit of the setting value is "0").
In this case, make sure to set SV118 to "0". For high-accuracy binary resolution encoder, set the number of
pulses to four bite data of SV118 (high-order) and SV020 (low-order) in pulse(p) unit.
SV118 = number of pulses / 65536 (when =0, set "-1" to SV118)
SV019 = the remainder of "number of pulses / 65536"
---Setting range---
When SV118 = 0, the setting range is from 0 to 32767 (kp)
When SV118≠0, the setting range is from 0 to 65535 (p)
#2221 SV021 OLT Overload detection time constant
Normally, set to "60". (For Mitsubishi adjustment.)
135 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 136
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
HEX- 4 3 2 1
mtyp
ent
pen
137 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
For linear motor and direct-drive motor, follow the settings stated in respective materials.
#2226 SV026 OD2 Excessive error detection width during servo OFF
Set the excessive error detection width during servo OFF.
When set to "0", the excessive error alarm detection will be ignored, so do not set to "0".
<Standard setting value>
OD1=OD2= (Rapid traverse rate [mm/min]) / (60×PGN1) / 2 [mm]
IB-1501229-F 138
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
bit F :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit E : zrn2
Set to "1". (Fixed)
bit D :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit C :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit B-A : ovs Overshooting compensation
Set this if overshooting occurs during positioning.
bitB,A=
00: Compensation stop
01: Setting prohibited
10: Setting prohibited
11: Type 3
Set the compensation amount in SV031(OVS1) and SV042(OVS2).
139 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
bit 2 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 1-0 : vcnt Speed loop delay compensation changeover type selection
Normally, use "Changeover type 2".
bit1,0=
00: Disable
01: Changeover type 1
10: Changeover type 2
11: Setting prohibited
IB-1501229-F 140
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
Type 3 SV027/bitB,A=11
Set the compensation amount based on the motor stall current. Observing positioning droop waveform,
increase in increments of 1% and find the value where overshooting does not occur.
141 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
nfd1
fhz3
nfd2
rps
zup
lmc2a
0: mm/min 1: 100mm/min
IB-1501229-F 142
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
has2
mohn
dcd
linN
ovsn
143 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
ckab
cltq
clstp
cl2n
clG1
clt
IB-1501229-F 144
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
(PR) #2236 SV036 PTYP Power supply type/ Regenerative resistor type
MDS-E/EH Series: Power supply type
When connecting a power supply unit, set a code for each power supply unit.
ptyp
rtyp
amp
When the emergency stop input signal of the power supply unit is "enabled"
(Note) Set the power supply rotary switch to "4".
Power supply unit is not connected : 00
MDS-E-CV-37 / MDS-EH-CV-37 : 44
MDS-E-CV-75 / MDS-EH-CV-75 : 48
MDS-E-CV-110 / MDS-EH-CV-110 : 51
MDS-E-CV-185 / MDS-EH-CV-185 : 59
MDS-E-CV-300 / MDS-EH-CV-300 : 70
MDS-E-CV-370 / MDS-EH-CV-370 : 77
MDS-E-CV-450 / MDS-EH-CV-450 : 85
MDS-E-CV-550 / MDS-EH-CV-550 : 95
MDS-EH-CV-750 : B5
MDS-EM/EMH Series
Not used. Set to "0000".
External emergency stop power supply type is set by spindle parameter (SP032).
145 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
0 0 0 0
emgx
rtyp
amp
MR-RB1H-4 : 33
MR-RB3M-4 : 34
MR-RB3G-4 : 35
MR-RB5G-4 : 36
bit 7-4 : emgx External emergency stop function
Set the external emergency stop function.
0: Disable 4: Enable
bit 3-0 :
Not used. Set to "0".
#2237 SV037 JL Load inertia scale
Set the motor axis conversion total load inertia including motor itself in proportion to the motor inertia.
SV037(JL)=(Jm+Jl)/Jm×100
Jm: Motor inertia
Jl: Motor axis conversion load inertia
For linear motor, set the gross mass of the moving sections in kg unit.
IB-1501229-F 146
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
147 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 148
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
149 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 150
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
#2261 SV061 DA1NO D/A output ch1 data No. / Initial DC excitation level
Input the data number you wish to output to the D/A output channel 1.
When using the 2-axis drive unit, set "-1" to the axis that the data will not be output.
151 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
Compensation amount (μm) = Command speed F(mm/min)2 * SV065 / (Radius R(mm) * SV003 *
16,200,000)
absc
szchk
npg
bit F-A:
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 9: npg Earth fault detection
0: Disable 1: Enable (standard)
Set "0" and it is constantly "Enable" for MDS-EJ/EJH Series.
bit 8:
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 7: szchk Distance-coded reference scale reference mark
0: Check at 4 points (standard) 1: Check at 3 points
bit 6-4:
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 3: absc Distance-coded reference scale
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit 2-0:
Not used. Set to "0".
IB-1501229-F 152
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
lmc3
ccu
dos2
dos3
bit F-C:
Not used. Set to "0".
bit B-A: dos3 Digital signal output 3 selection
bitB,A=
00: Disable
01: Setting prohibited
10: Contactor control signal output (For MDS-EJ/EJH)
11: Setting prohibited
bit 9-8: dos2 Digital signal output 2 selection
bit9,8=
00: Disable
01: Specified speed output
10: Setting prohibited
11: Setting prohibited
bit 7-3:
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 2: ccu Lost motion overshoot compensation compensation amount setting increment
0: Stall current % 1: Stall current 0.01%
bit 1: lmc3 Lost motion compensation type 3
Set this when protrusion at a quadrant change is too big.
0: Stop 1: Start
153 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
nfd4
nfd5
bit F-8 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 7-5 : nfd5 Depth of Notch filter 5
Set the depth of Notch filter 5 (SV088).
bit7,6,5=
000: -∞
001: -18.1[dB]
010: -12.0[dB]
011: -8.5[dB]
100: -6.0[dB]
101: -4.1[dB]
110: -2.5[dB]
111: -1.2[dB]
bit 4 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 3-1 : nfd4 Depth of Notch filter 4
Set the depth of Notch filter 4 (SV087).
bit3,2,1=
000: -∞
001: -18.1[dB]
010: -12.0[dB]
011: -8.5[dB]
100: -6.0[dB]
101: -4.1[dB]
110: -2.5[dB]
111: -1.2[dB]
bit 0 :
Not used. Set to "0".
IB-1501229-F 154
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
irms
ilm2u
odu
oru
h2c
155 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 156
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
Related parameters:
SV032 : The pull up direction is determined. When "0" is set, the alarm occurs.
SV033/bitE : Start-up of the pull up function
SV048 : Set the drop prevention time. When "0" is set, the alarm occurs.
---Setting range---
0 to 2000 (μm)
#2296-2305 SV096 - SV105
Not used. Set to "0".
#2306 SV106 PGM OMR-FF scale model gain
Set the scale model gain (position response) in OMR-FF control.
Set the same value as SV003(PGN1).
Increase the setting value to perform a high-speed machining such as a fine arc or to improve the path er-
ror.Lower the value when vibration occurs during acceleration/deceleration.
Set to "0" when not using OMR-FF control.
---Setting range---
0 to 300 (rad/s)
#2307-2311 SV107 - SV111
Not used. Set to "0".
#2312 SV112 IFF OMR-FF current feed forward gain
Set the current feed forward rate in OMR-FF control.
The standard setting is "10000".
Setting value of "0" is equal to "10000(100%)" setting.
Set to "0" when not using OMR-FF control.
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (0.01%)
#2313 SV113 SSF8 Servo function 8
Select the servo functions.
A function is assigned to each bit.
Set this in hexadecimal format.
omrffon
nmerc
sto
bit F-9 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 8 : sto Dedicated wiring STO function
Set this parameter to use dedicated wiring STO function.
0: Dedicated wiring STO function unused 1: Dedicated wiring STO function used
(Only for MDS-E/EH and MDS-EJ/EJH)
bit 7 : nmerc Machine error compensation amount
(Note) Do not turn ON the NC power supply with the setting as disable (set to "1"). The initial parameter error
alarm is detected.
0: Enable (Normal setting) 1: Disable
bit 0 : omrffon OMR-FF control enabled
0: Disable 1: Enable
157 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
cse
nohis
bit F-9 :
Set to "8" when HG46, 56, 96 motors are driven by MDS-E-V3.
Set to "0" for other cases.
bit 8 : nohis History of communication error alarm between NC and DRV (34, 36, 38, 39)
0: Enable 1: Disable
bit 7 : cse Command speed monitoring function
0: Disable 1: Enable (Normal setting)
bit 6-0 :
Not used. Set to "0".
IB-1501229-F 158
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
esn
dfhz
dsn
ade1
ade2
ade4
ade5
dsl
are
bitE,D,C=
000 : Estimated resonance frequency (Normal display)
001 : Notch filter 1 frequency
010 : Notch filter 2 frequency
011 : Notch filter 3 frequency (always displays 1125Hz)
100 : Notch filter 4 frequency
101 : Notch filter 5 frequency
Other settings: setting prohibited
bit B : ade5 Notch filter 5 / Adaptive follow-up function
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit A : ade4 Notch filter 4 / Adaptive follow-up function
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit 9 : ade2 Notch filter 2 / Adaptive follow-up function
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit 8 : ade1 Notch filter 1 / Adaptive follow-up function
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit 7-6 : dsn Estimated resonance frequency display holding time
Set the estimated resonance frequency display holding time to the "AFLT frequency" display on drive monitor
screen.
bit7,6=
00: 4 [s]
01: 8 [s]
10: 12 [s]
11: 16 [s]
159 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
bit5,4=
00: -10 to 10 [%]
01: -20 to 20 [%]
10: -30 to 30 [%]
11: -40 to 40 [%]
bit 3-0 : esn Sensitivity of estimated resonance frequency
Set the sensitivity of the estimated resonance frequency. Smaller setting value enables to detect smaller vi-
bration component, however, adaptive movement will be repeated frequently. Normally set this parameter to
"0".
IB-1501229-F 160
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
161 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 162
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
RTGM
(SV199)
VGN1
㻌㻌
(SV005)
RTGM
(SV199)
VGN1
㻌㻌
(SV005)
163 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 164
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
4.3 Setting the Initial Parameters for the Spindle Drive Unit
The spindle specification parameters and spindle parameters must be set before the spindle system can be started up.
The spindle related parameters are input from the NC. The input method differs according to the NC being used, so refer
to each NC Instruction Manual.
---Setting range---
0 to 999999 (r/min)
---Setting range---
0 to 999999 (r/min)
---Setting range---
0 to 30000 (ms)
165 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
(Note) When spindle zero point proximity switch detection is enabled, the rotation direction of the
orientation/zero point return (synchronous tapping, spindle/C axis) will follow Z phase detection
direction. And the speed will follow Z phase detection speed.
---Setting range---
1 to 99999 (r/min)
IB-1501229-F 166
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
---Setting range---
1 to 32767
---Setting range---
1 to 32767
167 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
< Setting parameters for the encoder with semi/full-closed loop control >
Set parameters depending on the encoder configured in the machine. For semi-closed loop, set the same value to the
main side and the sub side. For full-closed loop, set the encoder of the main side and the sub side.
When using the encoder interface unit MDS-EX-HR, use this with SP097 (RNG1ex).
Encoder
OSE-1024 (ABZ pulse): SP019=4096, SP097=-1
---Setting range---
When SP097=0, the setting range is from 0 to 32767 (kp)
When SP097 ≠ 0, the setting range is from 0 to 65535 (p)
---Setting range---
When SP098=0, the setting range is from 0 to 32767 (kp)
When SP098 ≠ 0, the setting range is from 0 to 65535 (p)
---Setting range---
-1 to 32767
IB-1501229-F 168
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
---Setting range---
-1 to 32767
---Setting range---
-1 to 32767 (° )
169 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
- Check the wiring and ensure the safety of the surroundings before starting the operation.
- Do not operate at high-speed rotation at first. After checking that there are no problems as abnormal noise,
vibration, etc. from the spindle at start up with no-load and small S commands, raise the S commands
gradually.
- When vibration or abnormal noise occurs during the test operation, adjust or set the speed gain or the notch
filter.
- For the first check of the orientation, the orientation should be executed gradually from small S commands.
IB-1501229-F 170
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
171 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 172
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
173 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 174
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
175 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 176
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
177 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 178
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
179 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
(4) 200V Standard motor SJ-DJ Series (Compact & Lightweight output)
200V SJ-DJ Series (Compact & Lightweight output)
Motor
SJ-DJ5.5/ SJ-DJ5.5/ SJ-DJ7.5/ SJ-DJ7.5/ SJ-DJ11/ SJ-DJ15/
Parameter
100-01 120-01 100-01 120-01 100-01 80-01
MDS-E-SP- 80 80 160 160 160 200
No. Abbrev. Details 80 80
MDS-E-SP2- 16080(L) 16080(L) 16080(L) -
16080(M) 16080(M)
SP001 PGV Position loop gain non-interpolation mode 15 15 15 15 15 15
SP002 PGN Position loop gain interpolation mode 33 33 33 33 33 33
SP003 PGS Position loop gain spindle synchronization 15 15 15 15 15 15
SP004 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP005 VGN1 Speed loop gain 1 150 150 150 150 150 150
SP006 VIA1 Speed loop lead compensation 1 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900
SP007 VIL1 Speed loop delay compensation 1 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP008 VGN2 Speed loop gain 2 150 150 150 150 150 150
SP009 VIA2 Speed loop lead compensation 2 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900
SP010 VIL2 Speed loop delay compensation 2 0 0 0 0 0 0
: : : : : : :
SP013 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP014 PY1 Minimum excitation rate 1 50 50 50 50 50 50
SP015 PY2 Minimum excitation rate 2 100 100 100 100 100 100
SP016 DDT Phase alignment deceleration rate 20 20 20 20 20 20
SP017 SPEC1 Spindle specification 1 000C 000C 000C 000C 000C 000C
SP018 SPEC2 Spindle specification 2 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000
SP019 RNG1 Sub side encoder resolution 2000 2000 2000 2000 2000 2000
SP020 RNG2 Main side encoder resolution 2000 2000 2000 2000 2000 2000
SP021 OLT Overload detection time constant 60 60 60 60 60 60
SP022 OLL Overload detection level 120 120 120 120 120 120
Excessive error detection width
SP023 OD1 120 120 120 120 120 120
(interpolation mode - spindle synchronization)
SP024 INP In-position width 875 875 875 875 875 875
SP025 INP2 2nd in-position width 875 875 875 875 875 875
SP026 TSP Maximum motor speed 10000 12000 10000 12000 10000 8000
SP027 ZSP Motor zero speed 25 25 25 25 25 25
SP028 SDTS Speed detection set value 1000 1200 1000 1200 1000 800
SP029 SDTR Speed detection reset width 30 30 30 30 30 30
SP030 SDT2 2nd speed detection setting value 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP031 MTYP Motor type 2200 2200 2200 2200 2200 2200
SP032 PTYP Power supply type/ Regenerative resistor type - - - - - -
SP033 SFNC1 Spindle function 1 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000
SP034 SFNC2 Spindle function 2 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000
SP035 SFNC3 Spindle function 3 1600 1600 1600 1600 1600 1600
SP036 SFNC4 Spindle function 4 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000
SP037 JL Load inertia scale 100 100 100 100 100 100
SP038 FHz1 Notch filter frequency 1 0 0 0 0 0 0
: : : : : : :
SP046 FHz2 Notch filter frequency 2 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP047 EC Inductive voltage compensation gain 100 100 100 100 100 100
SP048 LMC1 Lost motion compensation 1 0 0 0 0 0 0
: : : : : : :
SP052 DFBN Dual feedback control non-sensitive band 0 0 0 0 0 0
Excessive error detection width
SP053 ODS 2000 2400 2000 2400 2000 1600
(non-interpolation mode)
SP054 ORE Overrun detection width in closed loop control 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP055 EMGx Max. gate off delay time after emergency stop 5000 5000 5000 5000 5000 5000
SP056 EMGt Deceleration time constant at emergency stop 300 300 300 300 300 300
SP057 GRA1 Spindle side gear ratio 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP058 GRA2 Spindle side gear ratio 2 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP059 GRA3 Spindle side gear ratio 3 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP060 GRA4 Spindle side gear ratio 4 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP061 GRB1 Motor side gear ratio 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP062 GRB2 Motor side gear ratio 2 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP063 GRB3 Motor side gear ratio 3 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP064 GRB4 Motor side gear ratio 4 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP065 TLM1 Torque limit 1 10 10 10 10 10 10
SP066 TLM2 Torque limit 2 10 10 10 10 10 10
SP067 TLM3 Torque limit 3 10 10 10 10 10 10
SP068 TLM4 Torque limit 4 10 10 10 10 10 10
SP069 PCMP Phase alignment completion width 875 875 875 875 875 875
SP070 KDDT Phase alignment deceleration rate scale 0 0 0 0 0 0
Variable current limit during deceleration,
SP071 DIQM 45 35 45 35 45 40
lower limit value
Variable current limit during deceleration,
SP072 DIQN 4500 4500 4500 4500 4500 3300
break point speed
SP073 VGVN Variable speed gain target value 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP074 VGVS Variable speed gain change start speed 0 0 0 0 0 0
Slip compensation scale during regeneration high-
SP075 DWSH 0 0 0 0 0 0
speed coil
IB-1501229-F 180
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
181 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 182
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
183 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 184
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
185 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 186
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
187 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 188
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
189 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 190
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
191 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 192
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
(8) 200V Standard motor SJ-V Series (Wide range constant output)
200V Standard motor SJ-V Series (Wide range constant output)
Motor
SJ-V11- SJ-V11- SJ-V15- SJ-V18.5- SJ-V22- SJ-V22- SJ-VK22-
Parameter
01T 09T 03T 03T 05T 09T 19ZT
No. Abbrev. Details MDS-E-SP- 160 160 200 240 320 320 320
SP001 PGV Position loop gain non-interpolation mode 15 15 15 15 15 15 15
SP002 PGN Position loop gain interpolation mode 33 33 33 33 33 33 33
SP003 PGS Position loop gain spindle synchronization 15 15 15 15 15 15 15
SP004 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP005 VGN1 Speed loop gain 1 150 150 150 150 150 150 150
SP006 VIA1 Speed loop lead compensation 1 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900
SP007 VIL1 Speed loop delay compensation 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP008 VGN2 Speed loop gain 2 150 150 150 150 150 150 150
SP009 VIA2 Speed loop lead compensation 2 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900 1900
SP010 VIL2 Speed loop delay compensation 2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP011 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP012 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP013 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP014 PY1 Minimum excitation rate 1 50 50 50 50 50 50 50
SP015 PY2 Minimum excitation rate 2 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
SP016 DDT Phase alignment deceleration rate 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
SP017 SPEC1 Spindle specification 1 000C 000C 000C 000C 000C 000C 000C
SP018 SPEC2 Spindle specification 2 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0020
SP019 RNG1 Sub side encoder resolution 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000
SP020 RNG2 Main side encoder resolution 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000
SP021 OLT Overload detection time constant 60 60 60 60 60 60 60
SP022 OLL Overload detection level 120 120 120 120 120 120 120
Excessive error detection width
SP023 OD1 120 120 120 120 120 120 120
(interpolation mode - spindle synchronization)
SP024 INP In-position width 875 875 875 875 875 875 875
SP025 INP2 2nd in-position width 875 875 875 875 875 875 875
SP026 TSP Maximum motor speed 6000 6000 6000 8000 6000 4500 6000
SP027 ZSP Motor zero speed 25 50 25 50 25 25 25
SP028 SDTS Speed detection set value 600 600 600 800 600 450 484
SP029 SDTR Speed detection reset width 30 30 30 30 30 30 30
SP030 SDT2 2nd speed detection setting value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP031 MTYP Motor type 2200 2200 2200 2200 2200 2200 2200
SP032 PTYP Power supply type/ Regenerative resistor type - - - - - - -
SP033 SFNC1 Spindle function 1 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000
SP034 SFNC2 Spindle function 2 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000
SP035 SFNC3 Spindle function 3 1600 1600 1600 1600 1600 1600 1600
SP036 SFNC4 Spindle function 4 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000
SP037 JL Load inertia scale 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
SP038 FHz1 Notch filter frequency 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
: : : : : : : :
SP046 FHz2 Notch filter frequency 2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP047 EC Inductive voltage compensation gain 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
SP048 LMC1 Lost motion compensation 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
: : : : : : : :
SP052 DFBN Dual feedback control non-sensitive band 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Excessive error detection width
SP053 ODS 1200 1200 1200 1600 1200 900 1200
(non-interpolation mode)
SP054 ORE Overrun detection width in closed loop control 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP055 EMGx Max. gate off delay time after emergency stop 5000 5000 5000 5000 5000 5000 5000
SP056 EMGt Deceleration time constant at emergency stop 300 300 300 300 300 300 300
SP057 GRA1 Spindle side gear ratio 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP058 GRA2 Spindle side gear ratio 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP059 GRA3 Spindle side gear ratio 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP060 GRA4 Spindle side gear ratio 4 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP061 GRB1 Motor side gear ratio 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP062 GRB2 Motor side gear ratio 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP063 GRB3 Motor side gear ratio 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP064 GRB4 Motor side gear ratio 4 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SP065 TLM1 Torque limit 1 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
SP066 TLM2 Torque limit 2 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
SP067 TLM3 Torque limit 3 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
SP068 TLM4 Torque limit 4 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
SP069 PCMP Phase alignment completion width 875 875 875 875 875 875 875
SP070 KDDT Phase alignment deceleration rate scale 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Variable current limit during deceleration, lower limit
SP071 DIQM 60 100 50 35 60 65 45
value
Variable current limit during deceleration, break point
SP072 DIQN 3700 3000 3100 3100 3700 2900 2800
speed
SP073 VGVN Variable speed gain target value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
SP074 VGVS Variable speed gain change start speed 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Slip compensation scale during regeneration high-
SP075 DWSH 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
speed coil
Slip compensation scale during regeneration low-
SP076 DWSL 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
speed coil
193 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 194
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
195 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 196
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
197 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 198
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
199 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 200
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
201 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
(11) 400V Standard motor SJ-4-V Series (Wide range constant output)
Motor 400V Standard motor SJ-4-V Series (Wide range constant output)
Parameter SJ-4-V15-20T SJ-4-V22-16T
No. Abbrev. Details MDS-EH-SP- 100 160
SP001 PGV Position loop gain non-interpolation mode 15 15
SP002 PGN Position loop gain interpolation mode 33 33
SP003 PGS Position loop gain spindle synchronization 15 15
SP004 0 0
SP005 VGN1 Speed loop gain 1 150 150
SP006 VIA1 Speed loop lead compensation 1 1900 1900
SP007 VIL1 Speed loop delay compensation 1 0 0
SP008 VGN2 Speed loop gain 2 150 150
SP009 VIA2 Speed loop lead compensation 2 1900 1900
SP010 VIL2 Speed loop delay compensation 2 0 0
SP011 0 0
SP012 0 0
SP013 0 0
SP014 PY1 Minimum excitation rate 1 50 50
SP015 PY2 Minimum excitation rate 2 100 100
SP016 DDT Phase alignment deceleration rate 20 20
SP017 SPEC1 Spindle specification 1 200C 200C
SP018 SPEC2 Spindle specification 2 0000 0000
SP019 RNG1 Sub side encoder resolution 4000 4000
SP020 RNG2 Main side encoder resolution 4000 4000
SP021 OLT Overload detection time constant 60 60
SP022 OLL Overload detection level 120 120
Excessive error detection width
SP023 OD1 120 120
(interpolation mode - spindle synchronization)
SP024 INP In-position width 875 875
SP025 INP2 2nd in-position width 875 875
SP026 TSP Maximum motor speed 6000 6000
SP027 ZSP Motor zero speed 25 25
SP028 SDTS Speed detection set value 600 600
SP029 SDTR Speed detection reset width 30 30
SP030 SDT2 2nd speed detection setting value 0 0
SP031 MTYP Motor type 2200 2200
SP032 PTYP Power supply type/ Regenerative resistor type - -
SP033 SFNC1 Spindle function 1 0000 0000
SP034 SFNC2 Spindle function 2 0000 0000
SP035 SFNC3 Spindle function 3 1600 1600
SP036 SFNC4 Spindle function 4 0000 0000
SP037 JL Load inertia scale 100 100
SP038 FHz1 Notch filter frequency 1 0 0
: : :
SP046 FHz2 Notch filter frequency 2 0 0
SP047 EC Inductive voltage compensation gain 100 100
SP048 LMC1 Lost motion compensation 1 0 0
:
SP052 DFBN Dual feedback control non-sensitive band 0 0
Excessive error detection width
SP053 ODS 1200 1200
(non-interpolation mode)
SP054 ORE Overrun detection width in closed loop control 0 0
SP055 EMGx Max. gate off delay time after emergency stop 5000 5000
SP056 EMGt Deceleration time constant at emergency stop 300 300
SP057 GRA1 Spindle side gear ratio 1 1 1
SP058 GRA2 Spindle side gear ratio 2 1 1
SP059 GRA3 Spindle side gear ratio 3 1 1
SP060 GRA4 Spindle side gear ratio 4 1 1
SP061 GRB1 Motor side gear ratio 1 1 1
SP062 GRB2 Motor side gear ratio 2 1 1
SP063 GRB3 Motor side gear ratio 3 1 1
SP064 GRB4 Motor side gear ratio 4 1 1
SP065 TLM1 Torque limit 1 10 10
SP066 TLM2 Torque limit 2 10 10
SP067 TLM3 Torque limit 3 10 10
SP068 TLM4 Torque limit 4 10 10
SP069 PCMP Phase alignment completion width 875 875
SP070 KDDT Phase alignment deceleration rate scale 0 0
Variable current limit during deceleration,
SP071 DIQM 60 75
lower limit value
Variable current limit during deceleration,
SP072 DIQN 3700 4500
break point speed
SP073 VGVN Variable speed gain target value 0 0
SP074 VGVS Variable speed gain change start speed 0 0
Slip compensation scale during regeneration high-
SP075 DWSH 0 0
speed coil
Slip compensation scale during regeneration low-
SP076 DWSL 0 0
speed coil
SP077 IQA Q axis current lead compensation 4096 4096
IB-1501229-F 202
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
Motor 400V Standard motor SJ-4-V Series (Wide range constant output)
Parameter SJ-4-V15-20T SJ-4-V22-16T
No. Abbrev. Details MDS-EH-SP- 100 160
SP078 IDA D axis current lead compensation 4096 4096
SP079 IQG Q axis current gain 1024 1024
SP080 IDG D axis current gain 1024 1024
SP081 IQAL Q axis current lead compensation low-speed coil 0 0
: : :
SP088 FHz5 Notch filter frequency 5 0 0
SP089 TMKQ Spindle output stabilizing gain Q axis 0 0
SP090 TMKD Spindle output stabilizing gain D axis 0 0
: : :
SP112 0 0
SP113 OPLP Current command value for open loop 0 0
SP114 MKT Coil changeover gate cutoff timer 150 150
SP115 MKT2 Coil changeover current limit timer 250 250
SP116 MKIL Coil changeover current limit value 120 120
SP117 SETM Excessive speed deviation timer 12 12
SP118 MSFT Magnetic pole shift amount 0 0
SP119 0 0
: : :
SP128 DA2MPY D/A output ch2 output scale 0 0
SP129 Motor unique constants (H) 2 2
SP130 Motor unique constants (H) 58 80
SP131 Motor unique constants (H) 100 160
SP132 0 0
SP133 Motor unique constants (H) 8000 8000
SP134 Motor unique constants (H) 1250 1100
SP135 Motor unique constants (H) 1250 1100
SP136 Motor unique constants (H) 3365 3394
SP137 Motor unique constants (H) 73 68
SP138 Motor unique constants (H) 2865 2830
SP139 Motor unique constants (H) 2755 2888
SP140 Motor unique constants (H) 1919 1899
SP141 Motor unique constants (H) 191 190
SP142 Motor unique constants (H) 0 0
SP143 0 0
SP144 Motor unique constants (H) 0 0
SP145 Motor unique constants (H) 382 433
SP146 Motor unique constants (H) 435 436
SP147 Motor unique constants (H) 63 64
SP148 Motor unique constants (H) 2771 1862
SP149 Motor unique constants (H) 3406 5627
SP150 Motor unique constants (H) 1367 2091
SP151 Motor unique constants (H) 234 141
SP152 Motor unique constants (H) 90 90
SP153 Motor unique constants (H) 120 120
SP154 Motor unique constants (H) 150 150
SP155 Motor unique constants (H) 1038 1039
SP156 Motor unique constants (H) 0 0
SP157 0 0
SP158 Motor unique constants (H) 750 750
SP159 Motor unique constants (H) 750 750
SP160 Motor unique constants (H) 0 0
SP161 0 0
: : :
SP224 0 0
SP225 SFNC5 Spindle function 5 0000 0000
SP226 SFNC6 Spindle function 6 0000 0000
SP227 SFNC7 Spindle function 7 0000 0000
: : :
SP232 0000 0000
SP233 IVC Voltage non-sensitive band compensation 0 0
SP234 0 0
SP235 R2H Temperature compensation gain 0 0
SP236 WIH Temperature compensation time constant 0 0
SP237 TCF Torque command filter 500 500
SP238 SSCFEED Safely limited speed 0 0
SP239 SSCRPM Safely limited motor speed 0 0
SP240 0 0
: : :
SP256 0 0
203 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 204
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
205 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 206
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
207 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 208
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
209 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 210
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
211 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 212
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
The parameters with "(PR)" requires the CNC to be turned OFF after the settings. Turn the power OFF and ON to enable
the parameter settings.
213 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
(Note) When setting a value at "50 or more", check if there is no problem with gear noise, motor excitation
noise, vibration during low-speed rotation or vibration when the servo is locked during orientation stop, etc.
When setting a value at "less than 50", check if there is no problem with the impact load response or rigidity
during servo lock.
---Setting range---
0 to 100 (%)
IB-1501229-F 214
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
fdir2
dfbx
seqh
vfb
fdir
msr
215 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
oplp
mkch
spsu
mpg
bit F-A :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 9 : mpg Earth fault detection
0: Disable 1: Enable (standard)
Set "0" and it is constantly "Enable" for MDS-EJ-SP Series.
bit 8 : spsu Command speed limit value
0: 33,750 r/min 1: 135,000 r/min
bit 7-6 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 5 : mkch Coil switch function
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit 4-2 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 1 : oplp Open loop control
This allows the operation in which no encoder feedback signals are used.
It is used when adjusting the encoder, etc.
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit 0 :
Not used. Set to "0".
IB-1501229-F 216
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
When using the encoder interface unit MDS-EX-HR, use this with SP097(RNG1ex).
Encoder
OSE-1024 (ABZ pulse): SP019=4096, SP097=-1
217 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 218
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
(PR) #13032 SP032 PTYP Power supply type/ Regenerative resistor type
MDS-E/EH Series: Power supply type
When connecting a power supply unit, set a code for each power supply unit.
ptyp
rtyp
amp
When the emergency stop input signal of the power supply unit is "enabled"
(Note) Set the power supply rotary switch to "4".
Power supply unit is not connected : 00
MDS-E-CV-37 / MDS-EH-CV-37 : 44
MDS-E-CV-75 / MDS-EH-CV-75 : 48
MDS-E-CV-110 / MDS-EH-CV-110 : 51
MDS-E-CV-185 / MDS-EH-CV-185 : 59
MDS-E-CV-300 / MDS-EH-CV-300 : 70
MDS-E-CV-370 / MDS-EH-CV-370 : 77
MDS-E-CV-450 / MDS-EH-CV-450 : 85
MDS-E-CV-550 / MDS-EH-CV-550 : 95
MDS-EH-CV-750 : B5
219 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
ptyp
rtyp
amp
0 0 0 0
emgx
rtyp
amp
IB-1501229-F 220
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
vfct
bit F-C :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit B-A : ovs Overshoot compensation
Set this parameter when overshooting occurs during positioning.
bitB,A=
00: Compensation stop
01: Setting prohibited
10: Setting prohibited
11: Compensation type 3
221 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
fhz3
bit C :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit B-9 : nfd4 Depth of Notch filter 4
Set the depth of Notch filter 4 (SP087).
bit B,A,9=
000: -∞
001: -18.1[dB]
010: -12.0[dB]
011: -8.5[dB]
100: -6.0[dB]
101: -4.1[dB]
110: -2.5[dB]
111: -1.2[dB]
bit 8 : pwm Current control
0: Standard current control 1: High frequency current control
bit 7-5 : nfd2 Depth of Notch filter 2
Set the depth of Notch filter 2 (SP046).
bit7,6,5=
000: -∞
001: -18.1[dB]
010: -12.0[dB]
011: -8.5[dB]
100: -6.0[dB]
101: -4.1[dB]
110: -2.5[dB]
111: -1.2[dB]
bit 4 : fhz3 Notch filter 3
0: Stop 1: Start (1125Hz)
IB-1501229-F 222
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
223 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
vgin
pyin
rtt_vgn
vgn
pyn
shgn
bit F-D :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit C : shgn SHG control in interpolation mode
0: Stop 1: Start
When using the OMR-FF control, set to "0".
bit B :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit A : pyn Excitation rate selection in interpolation mode
0: Select Excitation rate 1 1: Select Excitation rate 2
bit 9 : vgn Speed loop gain set selection in interpolation mode
0: Select Set 1 1: Select Set 2
bit 8-7 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 6 : rtt_vgn Real-time tuning I in non-interpolation mode / speed gain adaptation stop
0: Stop 1: Start
bit 5-3 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 2 : pyin Excitation rate selection in non-interpolation mode
The excitation rate after the in-position can be selected.
0: Select Excitation rate 1 1: Select Excitation rate 2
bit 1 : vgin Speed loop gain set selection in non-interpolation mode
The speed loop gain set after the in-position can be selected.
0: Select Set 1 1: Select Set 2
bit 0 :
Not used. Set to "0".
IB-1501229-F 224
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
vgs
pys
shgs
rtt_vgns
mksl
bit F-8 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 7 : mksl Coil selection in spindle synchronization mode
0: Select the coil commanded during synchronization 1: Select high-speed coil
bit 6 : rtt_vgns Real-time tuning I in spindle synchronization mode / speed gain adaptation stop
0: Stop 1: Start
bit 5 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 4 : shgs SHG control in spindle synchronization mode
0: Stop 1: Start
When using the OMR-FF control, set to "0".
bit 3 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 2 : pys Excitation rate selection in spindle synchronization mode
0: Select Excitation rate 1 1: Select Excitation rate 2
bit 1 : vgs Speed loop gain set selection in spindle synchronization mode
0: Select Set 1 (SP005,SP006,SP007) 1: Select Set 2 (SP008,SP009,SP010)
bit 0 :
Not used. Set to "0".
#13037 SP037 JL Load inertia scale
Set the motor axis conversion total load inertia including motor itself in proportion to the motor inertia.
SV037(JL)=(Jm+Jl)/Jm×100
Jm: Motor inertia
Jl: Motor axis conversion load inertia
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (%)
#13038 SP038 FHz1 Notch filter frequency 1
Set the vibration frequency to suppress when machine vibration occurs.
(Enabled at 50 or more.)
When not using, set to "0".
225 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 226
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
227 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
When set to "0", the excessive error detection will not be performed.
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (°)
#13054 SP054 ORE Overrun detection width in closed loop control
Set the overrun detection width in the full-closed loop control.
When the gap between the motor side encoder and the machine side encoder exceeds the set value, it is
judged as an overrun and "Alarm 43" is detected.
When "-1" is set, if the differential velocity between the motor side encoder and the machine side encoder
exceeds the 30% of the maximum motor speed, it will be judged as overrun and "Alarm 43" will be detected.
When "0" is set, overrun will be detected with 2°.
In the full-closed loop control, normally set this parameter to "360". During V-belt drive, set to "-1".
---Setting range---
-1 to 32767 (°)
#13055 SP055 EMGx Max. gate off delay time after emergency stop
Set the time required to forcibly execute READY OFF after the emergency stop is input.
Normally set to "5000".
When 5000ms or more is set for deceleration time constant at emergency stop(SP056), set the same value
as SP056.
When using the power backup system (MDS-D/DH-PFU) and setting the value of this parameter to 5000ms
or more, a communication error between NC and drive unit may occur when power restarts after a instanta-
neous power interrupt.
It is not a problem so turn the NC power ON again to start up.
When "0" is set, 7000ms is the actual value to be set.
IB-1501229-F 228
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
229 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
100%
SP152
DIQM
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (%)
#13072 SP072 DIQN Variable current limit during deceleration, break point
speed
Set this parameter to adjust the deceleration time by changing the current limit value during deceleration de-
pending on the motor speed.
As shown below, set the lower limit rate of the current limit in SP071 (DIQM), and use with SP072 (DIQN).
When DIQM is set to 100%, the standard current limit value in deceleration (SP152) is applied.
100%
SP152
DIQM
---Setting range---
1 to 32767 (r/min)
IB-1501229-F 230
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
VGVN
(SP073)
>100
100 100
VGVN
(SP073)
<100
Motor speed Motor speed
[r/min] [r/min]
VGVS VLMT VGVS VLMT
(SP074) (SP026x1.15) (SP074) (SP026x1.15)
When lowering the speed loop gain at high speed When increasing the speed loop gain at high speed
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (%)
#13074 SP074 VGVS Variable speed gain change start speed
If noise is bothersome during high speed rotation, it may be reduced by lowering the speed loop gain at high
speed.
Set this value to ensure the adequate response by suppressing noise and vibration at low speeds and in-
creasing the speed loop gain at high speeds for a high-speed spindle of machining center, etc.
As shown below, set the speed loop gain rate for the overspeed detection speed in SP073 (VGVN), and use
with SP074 (VGVS).
When not using, set to "0".
The overspeed detection speed (VLMT) is 115% of the maximum motor speed (TSP).
This function can be used when either Speed loop gain set 1 or Speed loop gain set 2 is selected.
Scale[%] Scale[%]
VGVN
(SP073)
>100
100 100
VGVN
(SP073)
<100
Motor speed Motor speed
[r/min] [r/min]
VGVS VLMT VGVS VLMT
(SP074) (SP026x1.15) (SP074) (SP026x1.15)
When lowering the speed loop gain at high speed When increasing the speed loop gain at high speed
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (r/min)
231 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 232
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
233 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
Ten-thousands digit, Thousands digit ------------ Command motor speed level (10r/min)
Hundreds digit, Tens digit, Ones digit ----------- Motor speed level (10r/min)
---Setting range---
0 to 31999
#13095 SP095 VIAX Lead compensation scale during high-response accel-
eration/deceleration
Set the magnification against delay/lead compensation (SP006) of the high-response acceleration/deceler-
ation (valid when SP226/ bitD is set to "1").
Normally, set to "0". Set this parameter to suppress overshooting when the speed is reached.
---Setting range---
0 to 10000 (0.01%)
#13096 SP096 SDW Speed slowdown allowable width
When the spindle slows down due to multiple cutting, set the processable speed as percentage against the
NC command speed.
When "0" is set, the magnification is the same as when "85" is set. When set to "-1", the allowable width will
be disabled.
---Setting range---
-1,0 to 100(%)
#13097 SP097 RNG1ex Extension sub side encoder resolution
When setting the machine side encoder resolution in pulse (p) unit, set the number of pulses to four bite data
of SP097 (high-order) and SP019 (low-order) in pulse (p) unit.
IB-1501229-F 234
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
235 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 236
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
#13125 SP125 DA1NO D/A output ch1 data No. / Initial DC excitation level
Input the desired data number to D/A output channel.
When using the 2-axis drive unit, set "-1" to the axis that the data will not be output.
237 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 238
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
The speed loop gain SP199(RTGM) changes in response to the estimated inertia ratio SP200(RTJX) based
on the speed loop gain SP005(VGN1) and the inertia multiplier SP037(JL) which were adjusted when no
workpiece was mounted.
When SP199 is set to "0", the adaptation of the speed loop gain will be disabled.
RTGM
(SP199)
VGN1
㻌㻌
(SP005)
The speed loop gain SP199(RTGM) changes in response to the estimated inertia ratio SP200(RTJX) based
on the speed loop gain SP005(VGN1) and the inertia multiplier SP037(JL) which were adjusted when no
workpiece was mounted.
When SP199 is set to "0", the adaptation of the speed loop gain will be disabled.
RTGM
(SP199)
VGN1
㻌㻌
(SP005)
239 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
#13201- SP201-SP224
13224
Not used. Set to "0".
#13225 SP225 SFNC5 Spindle function 5
Select the spindle functions.
Functions are allocated to each bit.
Set this in hexadecimal format.
mohn
thtyp
dcd
ddir
thno
mken
ovsn
IB-1501229-F 240
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
pon
r2c
tqof
vup
obs
bit F :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit E : obs Disturbance observer
0: Normal 1: Enable
bit D : vup High response acceleration / deceleration
This suppresses a temporal delay which occurs when the target speed is attained from acceleration and
when the spindle stops from deceleration.
0: Normal acceleration/deceleration 1: High response acceleration/deceleration Enable
bit C : tqof Spindle output stabilization during acceleration
0: Normal 1: Disable
bit B-9 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 8 : r2c Temperature compensation adjustment indicator
0: Normal 1: Display
bit 7-6 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 5 : pon IPM spindle pulse application magnetic pole estimation
0: Normal 1: Enable
bit 4-0 :
Not used. Set to "0".
241 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
ccu
dos3
dis
IB-1501229-F 242
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
omrffon
sto
sdt2
rps
bit F-E :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit D : rps Safely limited speed setting unit
0: Normal 1: 100°/min
bit C : sdt2 Specified speed output digital signal 2 output
0: Normal 1: Enable
bit B-9 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 8 : sto Dedicated wiring STO function
Set this parameter to use dedicated wiring STO function.
0: Dedicated wiring STO function unused 1: Dedicated wiring STO function used
(Only for MDS-E/EH and MDS-EJ/EJH)
bit 7-1 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 0 : omrffon OMR-FF control enabled
0: Disable 1: Enable
243 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
cse
nohis
pfdsr
bit F-C :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit B : pfdsr
Set the spindle stop operation at a power failure when the deceleration and stop function at power failure is
enabled.
Normal (Coast to a stop at power failure) : 0
Deceleration and stop at power failure : 1
bit A-9 :
Not used. Set to "0".
bit 8 : nohis History of communication error alarm between NC and DRV(34,36,38,39)
0: Enable 1: Disable
bit 7 : cse Spindle C axis command speed monitoring function
0: Normal setting (function disabled) 1: Function enabled
bit 6-0 :
Not used. Set to "0".
Related parameters: SP055, SP056
#13231 SP231
Not used. Set to "0000".
#13232 SP232
Not used. Set to "0000".
#13233 SP233 IVC Voltage non-sensitive band compensation
When 100% is set, the voltage equivalent to the logical non-energized time will be compensated.
When "0" is set, 100% compensation will be performed.
Adjust in increments of 10% from the default value 100%.
If the value is too large, vibration or vibration noise may be generated.
---Setting range---
0 to 255 (%)
#13234 SP234
Not used. Set to "0".
(PR) #13235 SP235 R2H Temperature compensation gain
Set the magnification in converting the thermistor temperature to the control compensation amount.
When "0" is set, the temperature compensation function is disabled.
When not using, or when using an IPM spindle motor, set to "0".
---Setting range---
0 to 400 (%)
IB-1501229-F 244
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
245 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
4 Setup
IB-1501229-F 246
5
Servo Adjustment
247 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
NO
Perform the adjustment so that vibration or
Mainly measure the position droop Set position loop gain overshooting does not occur.
waveform.
CAUTION
Perform adjusting the servo in the factory configuration of the machine. When the servo is adjusted without having an
enough running-in or a cover, friction torque, machine resonance frequency or resonance gain may be different, resulting in
an incorrect adjustment.
IB-1501229-F 248
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 20480
---Setting range---
1 to 20480
---Setting range---
1 to 8192
---Setting range---
1 to 8192
249 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
< When machine resonance does not occur at the standard VGN1 >
Set the standard VGN1. Use the standard value if no problem (such as machine resonance) occurs. If
sufficient cutting precision cannot be obtained at the standard VGN1, VGN1 can be raised above the standard
value as long as a 70 percent margin in respect to the machine resonance occurrence limit is maintained. The
cutting accuracy can also be improved by adjusting with the disturbance observer.
---Setting range---
1 to 30000
POINT
Suppressing the resonance with the vibration suppression function and increasing the VGN1 setting is effective for
adjusting the servo later.
IB-1501229-F 250
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
[ HG46 ] [ HG56 ]
50 50
40 40
30 30
Standard
VGN1
20 20
10 10
0 0
100 200 300 400 500 600 100 200 300 400 500 600
Load inertia magnification (%) Load inertia magnification (%)
[ HG75, HG54 ]
[ HG96 ] [ HG-H75,HG-H54 ]
100 250
80 200
60 150
Standard
VGN1
40 100
20 50
0 0
100 200 300 400 500 600 100 200 300 400 500 600
Load inertia magnification (%) Load inertia magnification (%)
250 500
200 400
150 300
Standard
VGN1
100 200
50 100
0 0
100 200 300 400 500 600 100 200 300 400 500 600
Load inertia magnification (%) Load inertia magnification (%)
251 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
250 250
200 200
150 150
Standard
VGN1
100 100
50 50
0 0
100 200 300 400 500 600 100 200 300 400 500 600
Load inertia magnification (%) Load inertia magnification (%)
500 500
400 400
300 300
Standard
VGN1
200 200
100 100
0 0
100 200 300 400 500 600 100 200 300 400 500 600
Load inertia magnification (%) Load inertia magnification (%)
500 750
400 600
300 450
Standard
VGN1
200 300
100 150
0 0
100 200 300 400 500 600 100 200 300 400 500 600
Load inertia magnification (%) Load inertia magnification (%)
IB-1501229-F 252
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
[ HG-H1502 ]
Isolated motor
600
500
400
300
Standard
VGN1
200
100
0
100 200 300 400 500 600
Load inertia magnification (%)
253 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Speed FB
0 0
Time Time
D/A output rang
0 0
Position Time Time
droop
Vibration waveform with lead compensation control Adjusted position droop waveform
If VIA is lowered, the position droop waveform becomes smooth and overshooting does not occur.
However, because the trackability in respect to the position commands becomes worse, the positioning time and
accuracy are sacrificed. VIA must be kept high (set the standard value) to guarantee precision, especially in high-
speed contour cutting (generally F = 1000 or higher). In other words, in a machine aiming for high speed and high
accuracy, a large enough value must be set in VGN1 so that VIA does not need to be lowered. When adjusting, the
cutting precision will be better if adjustment is carried out to a degree where overshooting does not occur and a high
VIA is maintained, without pursuing position droop smoothness.
If there are no vibration or overshooting problems, the high-speed contour cutting precision can be further improved
by setting the VIA higher than the standard value. In this case, adjust by raising the VIA in increments of 100 from
the standard value.
Setting a higher VIA improves the trackability regarding position commands in machines for which cycle time is
important, and the time to when the position droop converges on the in-position width is shortened.
It is easier to adjust the VIA to improve precision and cycle time if a large value (a value near the standard value)
can be set in VGN1, or if VGN1 can be raised equivalently using the disturbance observer.
---Setting range---
1 to 9999
POINT
Position droop vibration of 10Hz or less is not leading compensation control vibration. The position loop gain must be
adjusted.
IB-1501229-F 254
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 200 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
0 to 1200 (rad/s)
CAUTION
Always set the same value for the position loop gain between the interpolation axes.
255 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
(2) Setting the position loop gain for spindle synchronous control
During spindle synchronous control (synchronous tapping control, etc.), there are three sets of position loop gain
parameters besides the normal control.
---Setting range---
1 to 200 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
0 to 1200 (rad/s)
CAUTION
Always set the same value for the position loop gain between the spindle and servo synchronous axes.
IB-1501229-F 256
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
<Effect>
0.0 Control
method Roundness error (ȣm)
Conventional 22.5
control
-50.0
-50.0 0.0 50.0
(F=3000mm/min , ERROR=5.0μm/div)
During SHG control, PGN1, PGN2 and SHGC are set with the following ratio.
PGN1 : PGN2 : SHGC = 1 : 8/3 : 6
During SHG control even if the PGN1 setting value is the same, the actual position loop gain will be higher, so the
speed loop must have a sufficient response. If the speed loop response is low, vibration or overshooting could occur
during acceleration/deceleration in the same manner as conventional control. If the speed loop gain has been
lowered because machine resonance occurs, lower the position loop gain and adjust.
Setting Setting
No. Abbrev. Parameter name Setting example Explanation
ratio range
SV003 PGN1 1 to 200
Position loop gain 1 1 21 27 33 39 48
(SV049) (PGN1sp) (rad/s)
SV004 PGN2 Always set with a combination 0 to 999
Position loop gain 2 8/3 56 72 88 104 128
(SV050) (PGN2sp) of these three parameters. (rad/s)
SV057 SHGC 0 to 1200
SHG control gain 6 126 162 198 234 288
(SV058) (SHGCsp) (rad/s)
---Setting range---
1 to 9999
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (%)
257 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Feed forward is performed inside the drive unit according to the scale model and inertia setting in the OMR-FF
generation part, and can independently set the command trackability with the scale model position loop gain (PGM) and
the servo rigidity with the position control gain (PGN). This enables the higher and smoother trackability to the position
command.
This function can be highly effective for linear servo, direct drive motors, or general motors in semi-closed loop control.
OMR-FF control option for NC side is required when using this function.
SV037
(load inertia)
Scale
Position OMR-FF generation part
model
command
(PGM)
Position FF Speed FF Current FF
+ Position + +
control
+ Speed +
control
(PGN)
- -
S
Control target
CAUTION
1. Always set the load inertia scale when using this function because the parameter is crucial to this function.
If this function is enabled, the estimated inertia value is displayed as "0". If setting the load inertia scale, be sure to set it
before the adjustment for OMR-FF function.
2. Disable SHG control when using this function.
IB-1501229-F 258
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
259 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
When using the OMR-FF control, set the servo rigidity against quadrant projection or cutting load,
etc. For the tracking ability to the command, set by SV106(PGM).
---Setting range---
1 to 200 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
0 to 1200 (rad/s)
For linear motor, set the gross mass of the moving sections in kg unit.
---Setting range---
For general motor: 0 to 5000 (%)
For linear motor 0 to 5000 (kg)
IB-1501229-F 260
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
CAUTION
1. After the above adjustment, set SV106 in the interpolation axes to the same value as the axis with the lowest SV106
value.
2. Perform the above confirmation of accuracy in G61.1(G8P1)(high-accuracy) mode; use the constant and filter for high-
accuracy mode with OMR-FF function. Note that only #2010: fwd-g (Feed forward gain) will be disabled.
3. Feed forward gain (#2010 : fwd_g) on NC side will be disabled while this function is enabled
(#2139:omrff_off = "0").
4. The following functions will be disabled when using this function.
- Acceleration rate feed forward function
- Overshoot compensation function
261 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Normal?
NO
YES Measure the following with Waveform measurement
*Adjust according to (a), (b) or (c) function (Time-series data measurement) on NC Analyzer
(a) Decrease SV106 by "10" - Position droop → Overshooting does not occur
(b) Decrease SV112 by "1000" - Current feed back → Vibration does not occur
(c) Increase the time constant when axis stops
Completed
CAUTION
1. Always set the same value in the scale model gain of the interpolation axes when OMR-FF function is enabled.
2. Perform the above confirmation of accuracy in G61.1(G8P1)(high-accuracy) mode; use the constant and filter for high-
accuracy mode with OMR-FF function.
Note that only #2010: fwd-g (Feed forward gain) will be disabled.
IB-1501229-F 262
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 300 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (0.01%)
263 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Maximum tolerable current command value when adjusting the rapid traverse acceleration/deceleration time constant
MDS-E Series (200V) MDS-EH Series (400V)
Motor Max. current Motor Max. current Motor Max. current
model command value model command value model command value
HG46 Within 380% HG-H75 Within 350% HQ-H903 Within 250%
HG56 Within 390% HG-H105 Within 270% HQ-H1103 Within 210%
HG96 Within 260% HG-H54 Within 420%
HG75 Within 350% HG-H104 Within 350%
HG105 Within 270% HG-H154 Within 380%
HG54 Within 420% HG-H204 Within 310%
HG104 Within 350% HG-H354 Within 330%
HG154 Within 380% HG-H453 Within 250%
HG224 Within 310% HG-H703 Within 240%
HG204 Within 310% HG-H903 Within 290%
HG354 Within 420% HG-H1502 Within 190%
HG123 Within 190%
HG223 Within 230%
HG303 Within 240%
HG453 Within 300%
HG703 Within 240%
HG903 Within 290%
HG142 Within 190%
HG302 Within 210%
IB-1501229-F 264
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Maximum tolerable current command value when adjusting the cutting feed acceleration/deceleration time constant
MDS-E Series (200V) MDS-EH Series (400V)
Motor Max. current Motor Max. current Motor Max. current
model command value model command value model command value
HG46 Within 266% HG-H75 Within 245% HQ-H903 Within 175%
HG56 Within 273% HG-H105 Within 189% HQ-H1103 Within 147%
HG96 Within 182% HG-H54 Within 294%
HG75 Within 245% HG-H104 Within 245%
HG105 Within 189% HG-H154 Within 266%
HG54 Within 294% HG-H204 Within 217%
HG104 Within 245% HG-H354 Within 231%
HG154 Within 266% HG-H453 Within 175%
HG224 Within 217% HG-H703 Within 168%
HG204 Within 217% HG-H903 Within 203%
HG354 Within 294% HG-H1502 Within 133%
HG123 Within 133%
HG223 Within 161%
HG303 Within 168%
HG453 Within 205%
HG703 Within 168%
HG903 Within 203%
HG142 Within 133%
HG302 Within 147%
CAUTION
Always set the same value for the cutting feed time constant between the interpolation axes.
265 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 32767 (μm)
POINT
The in-position width setting and confirmation availability depend on the CNC parameters.
IB-1501229-F 266
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
F × 106 PGN1×G0tL
103 1− exp 㧙
Settling time ( ms) = 60 × G0tL × PGN12 103
PGN1
ln
INP
If machine resonance occurs, the resonance frequency can be confirmed at AFLT frequency on NC drive monitor
screen. Based on this frequency, the notch filter frequency can be set. When "0" is displayed, resonance is not occurring.
POINT
Suppress the vibration using the vibration suppression functions, and maintain the speed loop gain (SV005) as high as
possible.
267 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (Hz)
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (Hz)
IB-1501229-F 268
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (Hz)
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (Hz)
269 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Notch filter application ranges when the adaptive tracking function is available
Estimated adaptive Avail. Adaptive
Notch filter Adaptive range
frequency range operation
Notch filter 1 150 to 900 [Hz] SV115/bit8 Setting value(SV038)±Adaptive range (SV115/bit4,5) [Hz]
Notch filter 2 150 to 900 [Hz] SV115/bit9 Setting value (SV046)±Adaptive range (SV115/bit4,5) [Hz]
Notch filter 3 Not included Not included Not included
Notch filter 4 150 to 900 [Hz] SV115/bitA Setting value (SV087)±Adaptive range (SV115/bit4,5) [Hz]
Setting value (SV088)±Adaptive range (SV115/bit4,5) [Hz]
Notch filter 5 150 to 900 [Hz] SV115/bitB
(Note) When adaptive to all frequency (SV115/bitF) 150 to 900 [Hz]
CAUTION
If adaptive ranges are set too wide, frequency may fluctuate so greatly that the control can become unstable.
When the notch filter 5 is set adaptive to all frequency, the depth of the filter shall be set shallowly to enable stable
operation with low frequency.
IB-1501229-F 270
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
bitE,D,C=
000 : Estimated resonance frequency (Normal display)
001 : Notch filter 1 frequency
010 : Notch filter 2 frequency
011 : Notch filter 3 frequency (always displays 1125Hz)
100 : Notch filter 4 frequency
101 : Notch filter 5 frequency
Other settings: setting prohibited
bit B : ade5 Notch filter 5 / Adoptive follow-up function
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit A : ade4 Notch filter 4 / Adoptive follow-up function
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit 9 : ade2 Notch filter 2 / Adoptive follow-up function
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit 8 : ade1 Notch filter 1 / Adoptive follow-up function
0: Disable 1: Enable
bit 7-6 : dsn Estimated resonance frequency display holding time
Set the estimated resonance frequency display holding time to the "AFLT frequency" display on
drive monitor screen.
bit7,6=
00: 4 [s]
01: 8 [s]
10: 12 [s]
11: 16 [s]
bit 5-4 : dfhz Notch filter frequency range
Set the adaptive range of the notch filter frequency. When the adaptive follow-up function is enabled
and if the estimated resonance frequency exists in the set range, the notch filter will be adapted.
Normally set this parameter to "00".
bit5,4=
00: -10 to 10 [%]
01: -20 to 20 [%]
10: -30 to 30 [%]
11: -40 to 40 [%]
bit 3-0 : esn Sensitivity of estimated resonance frequency
Set the sensitivity of the estimated resonance frequency. Smaller setting value enables to detect
smaller vibration component, however, adoptive movement will be repeated frequently. Normally set
this parameter to "0".
271 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
POINT
Jitter compensation vibration suppression is only effective when the motor is stopped.
IB-1501229-F 272
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 30000
Gain
VGN1
VGN2
Speed
VCS VLMT
(Overspeed detection speed)
---Setting range---
-1000 to 30000
---Setting range---
0 to 9999 (r/min)
273 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
X
< Examples of faults >
• The surface precision in the 45° direction of a taper or arc is poor.
• The load fluctuation during cutting is large, causing vibration or surface precision defects to occur.
POINT
Adjust by raising the speed loop gain equivalently to improve cutting surface precision, even if the measures differ. In this
case, it is important how much the machine resonance can be controlled, so adjust making sufficient use of vibration
suppression functions.
IB-1501229-F 274
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 30000
---Setting range---
1 to 9999
Cutting direction
Motor torque Ҹ 0
Frictional torque
Balanced
Unbalance torque
Lowering
Deceleration torque = frictional torque
---Setting range---
0 to 255 (%)
275 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
For linear motor, set the gross mass of the moving sections in kg unit.
---Setting range---
For general motor: 0 to 5000 (%)
For linear motor 0 to 5000 (kg)
---Setting range---
0 to 1000 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
0 to 500 (%)
POINT
The lost motion compensation must be readjusted when the disturbance observer is started.
IB-1501229-F 276
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
3000
Speed command 0
(r/min) Time
-3000
200
Current FB 0
(stall current %) Time
-200
3000
Speed command 0
(r/min)
Time
-3000
200
Current FB 0
(stall current %) Time
-200
No. Abbrev. Parameter name Setting ratio Setting example Explanation Setting range
SV003 PGN1 1 to 200
Position loop gain 1 1 21 27 33 39 48
(SV049) (PGN1sp) Always set with (rad/s)
SV004 PGN2 a combination 0 to 999
Position loop gain 2 8/3 56 72 88 104 128
(SV050) (PGN2sp) of these three (rad/s)
SV057 SHGC parameters. 0 to 1200
SHG control gain 6 126 162 198 234 288
(SV058) (SHGCsp) (rad/s)
277 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
200 200
Current
command 100 100
(%)
0 0
0 20 40 60 80 100 0 20 40 60 80 100
Time (ms) Time (ms)
Acceleration rate feed forward gain means that the speed loop gain during acceleration/deceleration is raised
equivalently. Thus, the torque (current command) required during acceleration/deceleration starts sooner. The
synchronization precision will improve if the FFC of the delayed side axis is raised between axes for which high-
precision synchronous control (such as synchronous tapping control and superimposition control).
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (%)
POINT
Overshooting occurs easily when a value above the standard value is set during SHG control.
IB-1501229-F 278
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
3000
Speed command 0
(r/min) Time
-3000 No inductive voltage
compensation
200
Current
command
(Rated current %) 0
Time
With inductive
-200 voltage
compensation
---Setting range---
0 to 200 (%)
POINT
If the current FB peak (MAX current 3) becomes larger than the current command peak (MAX current 2)
(over compensation), an overcurrent (alarm 3A) will occur easily. Note that over compensation will occur easily
if the load inertia is large.
279 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
POINT
1. During G1 drive, if HAS control is started, the compensation amount can not be compensated. Therefore, adjust the feed
speed cramp value or acceleration/deceleration time constant so that the current limit does not occur.
2. HAS control can not be used for axes in synchronous control since machine torsion may be occur.
3. Even if HAS control is enabled, adjust the acceleration/deceleration time constant so that the current limit does not
occur.
4. If setting half of error excessive encoder width to the droop compensation amount, error excessive alarm in acceleration
may occur more easily than if 1/4.
IB-1501229-F 280
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Compensation
Cutting
direction
Circle cutting path before compensation Circle cutting path after compensation
POINT
1. LMC compensation performs adjustment while measuring the electrical end roundness waveform (encoder position FB).
Disable the NC side machine error compensation (pitch error compensation, relative position compensation, backlash
compensation). All machine error compensation can be disabled at once by setting SV113 to bit7.
2. After the compensation adjustment is completed, adjust the machine error compensation while measuring the machine
error compensation with DBB measurement method, etc.
281 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
(Example)
Assume that the load current % was -55% in the + direction and -25% in the - direction
when JOG feed was carried out at approx. F1000. The unbalance torque and frictional
torque are as shown below.
(-55) + (-25) = -40%
Unbalance torque (%) =
2
(-55) - (-25) = 15%
Friction torque (%) =
2
The measurement values are not used for LMC compensation type 3. However, since they are used for other
controls, set them to the following parameters.
---Setting range---
-100 to 100 (Stall current %)
---Setting range---
0 to 255 (Stall current %)
IB-1501229-F 282
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
-X +X
[7] Perform a roundness measurement at such speed as radius, R=100mm and feedrate, F=5000mm/min. (Select
a condition to be used for the actual cutting according to the machine's specification.) Adjust viscous
coefficient (SV086) by increasing and reducing it approx. ±500 gradually to have minimum quadrant
protrusion.
[8] After adjusting SV086, verify its accuracy by performing roundness measurement at low speed again.
[9] At this time, if requiring to improve the accuracy further, adjust the spring constant (SV085) in increments of
about 50 while performing the machine roundness measurement at low speed.
POINT
1. As the acceleration of circular feed increases, the quadrant protrusion tends to get larger. Therefore, the quadrant
protrusion gets larger as the circular feedrate increases for the same radius and as radius gets smaller for the same
feedrate.
2. Torque offset (SV032) does not work for LMC compensation type 3.
3. Always set 0 to the lost motion compensation timing (SV039:LMCD).
283 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
-1 to 200 (Stall current %)
Note that when SV082/bit2 is "1", the setting range is between -1 and 20000 (Stall current
0.01%).
---Setting range---
-1 to 200 (Stall current %)
Note that when SV082/bit2 is "1", the setting range is between -1 and 20000 (Stall current
0.01%).
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (0.01%/μm)
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (0.01%•s/mm)
IB-1501229-F 284
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 20000 (Stall current 0.01%)
Position
Speed command
FB
0 0
Position Position
droop droop
0 0
Overshoot Overshoot
Time Time
[1] Overshooting during rapid traverse settling [2] Overshooting during pulse feed
285 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
POINT
1. When either parameter SV031: OVS1 or SV042: OVS2 is set to 0, the same amount of compensation is carried out in
both the positive and negative direction, using the setting value of the other parameter (the parameter not set to 0).
2. To compensate in only one direction, set -1 in the parameter (OVS1 or OVS2) for the direction in which compensation is
prohibited.
3. For contour cutting, the projection at the arc end point is compensated with OVS compensation. LMC compensation is
carried out at the arc starting point.
Cutting direction
IB-1501229-F 286
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Type 3 SV027/bitB,A = 11
Set the compensation amount based on the motor stall current. Observing positioning droop
waveform, increase in increments of 1% and find the value where overshooting does not occur.
---Setting range---
-1 to 100 (Stall current %)
Note that the range will be "-1 - 10000" (Stall current 0.01%) when SV082/bit2 is "1".
---Setting range---
-1 to 100 (Stall current %)
Note that when SV082/bit2 is "1", the setting range is between -1 and 10000 (Stall current
0.01%).
287 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
POINT
When using feed forward control (high-speed high-accuracy control), stop the feed forward control (fwd_g=0)
before adjusting the overshooting compensation. If overshooting occurs during subsequent feed forward control,
adjust the feed forward gain (fwd_g).
High speed
(high acceleration):
Example:
Both low speed and
R25mm high speed are on
Command path Low speed: F10000mm /min the same path.
Example: Command path
(ideal path) R25mm (ideal path)
F1000mm/min
Without machine end compensation control With machine end compensation control
POINT
1. Always evaluate the roundness accuracy at the machine side.
2. Adjust the parameter after adjusting the electrical end roundness accuracy.
IB-1501229-F 288
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
[3] Input the value calculated in step [2] into SV065. Measure the high-speed circle path. If the shape is still
elliptical, adjust by increasing/decreasing the SV065 value in 1/10 units.
[4] Confirm that there is no problem with the low-speed circle path.
Example of low-speed and high-speed roundness measurement for adjusting machine compensation
When using grid encoder When using DBB measurement Acceleration
Low speed
R=25 [mm], F=500 [mm/min] R=100 [mm], F=1000 [mm/min] 0.00028G
(reference circle)
High-speed
(when adjusting R=25 [mm], F=10000 [mm/min] R=100 [mm], F=20000 [mm/min] 0.11G
compensation amount)
Compensation amount (μm) = Command speed F (mm/min)2 * SV065 / (Radius R (mm) * SV003 *
16,200,000)
---Setting range---
-30000 to 30000 (Acceleration ratio 0.1%)
POINT
1. To confirm the machine's spring element, adjust the electrical end roundness, and then machine roundness while
changing the cutting speed. Confirm that the error increases with the speed.
2. The electrical roundness will have an error on the inner side when machine end compensation control is used.
CAUTION
If an excessive value is set in the machine end compensation gain (SV065), the machine could vibrate when stopping,
resulting in a dangerous state.
289 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Table
Position droop Speed command
Servo
Position PGN motor
command +
- Linear scale
ENC
Position FB
FB error
+
- Position FB
---Setting range---
-1 to 32767 (mm)
However, when SV084/bitD=1, the setting range is from -1 to 32767 (μm).
IB-1501229-F 290
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 32767
---Setting range---
-100 to 100 (Stall current %)
bit 1-0 : vcnt Speed loop delay compensation changeover type selection
Normally, use "Changeover type 2".
bit1,0=
00: Disable
01: Changeover type 1
10: Changeover type 2
11: Setting prohibited
CAUTION
The position droop will remain if SV007 is set too high.
291 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Table
Speed
Position droop
Position command Servo
Position control
command + motor
- High frequency Linear scale
FB element ENC
Position FB
Low
frequency FB +
element - +
Primary
delay filter - Position FB
SV051
The state will approach the semi-closed loop system as the primary delay filter's time constant increases, so the position
loop gain limit will increase. Note that the limit of the position loop gain increased with the dual feedback function is the
same as the position loop gain limit for a semi-closed system that does not use a machine side encoder (scale, etc.). In
addition, the positioning time will increase as the primary delay filter time constant increases.
POINT
1. Dual feedback control is a function that compensates symptoms resulting from insufficient machine rigidity.
If there are items that can be improved on the machine (improvement of scale installation position, etc.)
improve those first.
2. The position loop gain limit will not increase compared to the semi-closed loop system even when using dual
feedback control.
IB-1501229-F 292
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 9999 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 9999 (μm)
293 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Table
Position droop Speed command
Position Position control Servo
command + + + motor
- Torsion Linear scale
compensation Filter ENC
amount (SV206) When the direction
is reversed
Motor-end position FB
Machine-end position FB
Reverse
Motor end
Required compensation amount =
Torsion Torsion compensation amount
amount (SV206)
Machine end
Torsion of the
reverse direction
Motor end
Determine the compensation amount
Torsion in the forward direction restart from
amount the torsion retract amount of the
motor-end position from when
movement is stopped.
Machine end
CAUTION
Always readjust the lost motion compensation when setting the torsion compensation amount (SV206).
IB-1501229-F 294
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Select "Setting" from the measurement screen and change Waveform type, which is in Channel setting
on "Sampling condition setting", from "Position FB" to "Motor end position".
295 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Measure the roundness and read the torsion amounts generated when the direction is reversed (linear
parts in the following figure). Set the smaller value of the read values to the parameter: SV206 (unit:
0.01μm) as the compensation amount.
Example: When the values are +X = 4.5μ m, -X = 4.2μ m, +Y = 3.9μ m, and -Y = 4.2μ m,
set SV206 for X axis to 420 and for Y axis to 390.
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (0.01μm)
Compensate the torsion amount in the forward direction with the full-closed torsion compensation
function. When compensating the torsion amount in the reverse direction only, set to "0".
0: Stop 1: Start
IB-1501229-F 296
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
CAUTION
If the deceleration control time constant at emergency stop (EMGt) is set to a value longer than the above value,
the soft limit point (stroke end point) may be exceeded. Take care as the axis could collide the machine.
297 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
S V056
Constant inclination
Motor speed deceleration
Time
【#2255】 SV055 EMGx Max. gate off delay time after emergency stop
Set the time required between an emergency stop and forced READY OFF.
Set the maximum value "+ 100ms" of the SV056 setting value of the servo drive unit electrified by the
same power supply unit.
When executing the vertical axis drop prevention, the gate off will be delayed for the length of time
set at SV048 even when SV055's is smaller than that of SV048.
---Setting range---
0 to 20000 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 20000 (ms)
IB-1501229-F 298
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
F 1 F x EMGt
L emg =
PGN1 x 60
+ × F × (mm)
2 60 rapid x 1000
POINT
1. Deceleration control will not take place when a servo alarm, for which the stopping method is dynamic, occurs.
The motor will stop with dynamic braking regardless of the parameter setting.
2. If the power fails and the deceleration time constant is set to a relatively long time, the braking method may change from
deceleration control to dynamic braking due to a drop in the bus voltage in the drive unit.
CAUTION
If the deceleration control time constant (EMGt) is set to a value longer than the acceleration/deceleration time
constant, the soft limit point (stroke end point) may be exceeded.
Take care as the axis could collide the machine.
299 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
ON
Emergency stop (EMG)
OFF
OFF
Motor brake control output(MBR)
ON
OFF
Motor brake actual operation (BRK)
ON
IB-1501229-F 300
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
CAUTION
1. Always set deceleration control when using the vertical axis drop prevention control setting.
2. Configure so that the power supply unit is controlled directly by the servo drive unit which controls the spindle drive unit
or the vertical axis drop prevention control.
3. In the 2nd part system of the power supply, if the axis for vertical axis drop prevention is connected with the CN9
connector of the power supply unit, provide the vertical axis drop prevention control setting also for the drive unit
connected with CN4 connector of the same power supply unit.
4. If an alarm, for which dynamic brake stopping is designated, occurs with the axis for which vertical axis drop prevention
control is active, the function will not activate. To prevent axis dropping under all conditions, provide measures on the
machine side by installing a balance unit, etc.
5. In consideration of the relay delay time for the break control, set the vertical axis drop prevention time.
(Note) When not using the spindle drive unit, use the servo axis that controls vertical axis drop
prevention control to control the power supply (connect with CN4).
---Setting range---
0 to 20000 (ms)
【#2255】 SV055 EMGx Max. gate off delay time after emergency stop
Set the time required between an emergency stop and forced READY OFF.
Set the maximum value "+ 100ms" of the SV056 setting value of the servo drive unit electrified by the
same power supply unit.
When executing the vertical axis drop prevention, the gate off will be delayed for the length of time
set at SV048 even when SV055's is smaller than that of SV048.
---Setting range---
0 to 20000 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 20000 (ms)
301 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
POINT
1. SV048 and SV055 are set for each axis, but when using MDS-E/EH-V2/V3 (2-axis or 3-axis drive unit), the axes are
controlled with the larger setting value.
2. If an alarm, for which dynamic brake stopping is designated, occurs with the axis for which vertical axis drop prevention
control is active, the function will not activate.
3. A drop amount of several µm to several 10µm may be generated due to brake play.
CAUTION
1. Do not set the vertical axis drop prevention time longer than required. The servo control and brakes could collide,
resulting in an overload alarm or drive unit damage. There is no problem if the overlapping time is within 100ms.
2. Vertical axis drop prevention control (including deceleration control) longer than 100ms will not be guaranteed during a
power failure. The operation will change to dynamic brakes.
3. If only SV048 and SV055 are set, and SV056 is set to 0, the deceleration stop will be a stepped stop and could result in
collision with the machine.
IB-1501229-F 302
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
NC
[2] Spindle drive unit controls power supply unit. Vertical axis is a 2-axis unit (vertical axis: Z axis).
NC
303 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
[3] Servo drive unit controls power supply unit. Vertical axis is a 1-axis unit (vertical axis: Z axis).
NC
[4] Servo drive unit controls power supply unit. Vertical axis is a 2-axis unit (vertical axis: Z axis).
NC
IB-1501229-F 304
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
[5] Spindle drive unit in the 2nd part system controls power supply unit.
Vertical axis is a 1-axis unit in the 1st part system (vertical axis: Z axis).
NC
(1st part system)
࣭࣭࣭
NC
(2nd part system)
࣭࣭࣭
Axis Axis other than the right Z axis (Vertical axis) Spindle
Parameter MDS-E/EH-V2 MDS-E/EH-V1 MDS-E/EH-SP
200ms as a standard
SV048 0 Set as follows.
(Set by adjustment)
SP055=5000
SV055 Each axis Maximum value of SV056 setting value +100ms
SP056=300
SV056 Standard setting value for each axis (Note)
(Note) For the standard setting value of SV056, refer to "Deceleration control".
CAUTION
In the 2nd part system of the power supply, if the axis for vertical axis drop prevention is connected with the CN9 connector
of the power supply unit, provide the vertical axis drop prevention control setting also for the drive unit connected with CN4
connector of the same power supply unit.
305 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
[6] Spindle drive unit in the 2nd part system controls power supply unit.
Vertical axis is a 2-axis unit in the 1st part system (vertical axis: Z axis).
NC
(1st part system)
࣭࣭࣭
NC
(2nd part system)
࣭࣭࣭
CAUTION
In the 2nd part system of the power supply, if the axis for vertical axis drop prevention is connected with the CN9 connector
of the power supply unit, provide the vertical axis drop prevention control setting also for the drive unit connected with CN4
connector of the same power supply unit.
IB-1501229-F 306
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
AC source input
Detection period of phase
interruption or instantaneous
power interrupt
ON
80μm(For PIT=10, PC1=1, PC2=1 or SV095=0)
Vertical axis pull-up control operation sequences when the power fails
CAUTION
1. This function is valid for Z axis in the vertical machining center. Basically it cannot be used with the horizontal machining
center's Y axis or the lathe's X axis as collisions could occur. Check the machine's working conditions carefully before
using this function.
2. When the power fails, charging energy remaining in the power supply unit executes the pull-up control. Thus, pull-up
range depends on charging situation of the power supply or the timing when the magnetic brake is applied.
---Setting range---
-100 to 100 (Stall current %)
307 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
(Note) When not using the spindle drive unit, use the servo axis that controls vertical axis drop
prevention control to control the power supply (connect with CN4).
---Setting range---
0 to 20000 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 2000 (μm)
For details concerning the overload protection characteristics, refer to the MDS-E/EH Series Specifications
Manual (IB-1501226).
---Setting range---
1 to 999 (s)
---Setting range---
110 to 500 (Stall current %)
IB-1501229-F 308
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (mm)
However, when SV084/bitC=1, the setting range is from 0 to 32767 (μm).
【#2226】 SV026 OD2 Excessive error detection width during servo OFF
Set the excessive error detection width during servo OFF.
<Standard setting value>
OD1=OD2= (Rapid traverse rate [mm/min]) / (60×PGN1) / 2 [mm]
When set to "0", the excessive error alarm detention will be ignored, so do not set to "0".
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (mm)
However, when SV084/bitC=1, the setting range is from 0 to 32767 (μm).
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (mm)
However, when SV084/bitC=1, the setting range is from 0 to 32767 (μm).
309 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
3000
Speed command
0
(r/min)
-3000
Estimated 0
torque (stall%)
G0 collision detection
-100 level ( SV060) Unbalance torque
G1 collision detection (SV032)
-200 level ( SV060×clG1)
CAUTION
The collision detection function does not guarantee safety or machine accuracy when a collision occurs.
Thus, the same caution as during regular operation is required to prevent the machine from colliding.
IB-1501229-F 310
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
POINT
1. Validate SHG control or OMR-FF function when using the collision detection function, or when carrying out SV059
setting value operation.
2. Provide an allowance in the detection level setting to prevent incorrect detections.
3. All collision detection functions will be disabled when SV60 is set to 0.
4. Collision detection method 2 will function if a value other than 0 is set in SV060. Note that the detection can be ignored
by setting the parameter (SV035/bitB).
5. The torque estimated gain (SV059) must be readjusted when there are changes in the encoder replacement following
maintenance, etc., in the encoder resolution, or in the position control system such as encoder loop gain (PGN), etc.
(closed loop control and semi-closed loop has been changed).
6. The retracting torque generated when a collision is detected outputs the motor maximum torque. If the torque limitation is
required in order to protect the machine, set "SV035 : SSF4/cltq (bit8, bit9)".
311 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
[4] Set SV035: SSF4.clt (bitF) to 1 for the axis being adjusted, and move in both directions with JOG, etc., at the
rapid traverse rate. When the load inertia ratio display on the NC SERVO MONITOR screen has stabilized, set
that value for the torque estimated gain (SV059: TCNV). Return SV035: SSF4.clt (bitF) to 0.
[5] If the acceleration/deceleration time is short, and the current is limited, set SV035: SSF4.c12n (bitB) to 1 to
invalidate collision detection method 2.
[6] Adjust the collision detection level (SV060: TLMT). First set 100. If operation at the rapid traverse rate results
in an alarm, increase the setting value by approx. 20. If an alarm does not occur, lower the setting value by
approx. 10. The estimated disturbance torque value on the servo monitor screen will indicate the estimated
disturbance torque peak value for the latest two seconds. This value can be used as reference. Set the final
setting value to a value approx. 1.5-fold the limit value at which an alarm does not occur.
[7] Divide the maximum cutting load with the value set for the collision detection level (SV060: TLMT). (Round up
the decimal) Set this value in SV035: SSF4.clG1 (bitC-E).
(Example) For maximum cutting load: 200%, SV060: TLMT setting value: 80%
200/80=2.5 -> The detection level is 3 (-fold), so set SV035:SSF4 to "3xxx".
[8] Set the retracting torque when the a collision is detected to SV035: SSF4.cltq (bit8,9).
(Example) To set the retracting torque to 70% of the motor maximum torque:
Set SV035:SSF4 to "x3xx".
---Setting range---
-100 to 100 (Stall current %)
IB-1501229-F 312
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 255 (Stall current %)
---Setting range---
For general motor: 0 to 5000 (%)
For linear motor: 0 to 5000 (kg)
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (Stall current %)
313 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
bit Details
0 RDY READY ON command
1 SRV Servo ON command
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 KPM Position loop gain changeover command
5 - (For maintenance)
6 EOM Excessive error detection width changeover command
7 ALMR Alarm reset command
8 IL1 Current limit selection command
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B - (For maintenance)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
IB-1501229-F 314
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
Name Details
Servo control input 2
F E D C B A 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
SRVDC NCDC SSW
bit Details
0 - (For maintenance)
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 - (For maintenance)
8 - (For maintenance)
9 SSW Speed monitor command valid
A NCDC In door closed (controller)
B SRVDC In door closed (all drive units)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
bit Details
0 AXF Control axis detachment command
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 - (For maintenance)
8 - (For maintenance)
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B - (For maintenance)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
315 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
bit Details
0 OMRFF OMR-FF control request
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 - (For maintenance)
8 DD1 Drivers communication control request
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B - (For maintenance)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
IB-1501229-F 316
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
bit Details
0 RDY In READY ON
1 SRV In servo ON
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 KPM In position loop gain changeover
5 - (For maintenance)
6 EOM In excessive error detection width changeover
7 ALMR In alarm
8 IL1 In current limit selection
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B - (For maintenance)
C INP In in-position
D LMT In current limit
E AER In absolute position data loss
F WRN In warning
317 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
Name Details
Servo control output 2
F E D C B A 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
SRVDC NCDC SSW EXEMG ZS ZCN
bit Details
0 ZCN Z phase passed
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 ZS In zero speed
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 EXEMG In external emergency stop
8 - (For maintenance)
9 SSW In speed monitor
A NCDC In door closed (controller)
B SRVDC In door closed (self drive unit)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
IB-1501229-F 318
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
bit Details
0 AXF In control axis detachment
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 - (For maintenance)
8 - (For maintenance)
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B - (For maintenance)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
bit Details
0 OMRFF In OMR-FF control
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 - (For maintenance)
8 DD1 In drivers communication control
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B - (For maintenance)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
319 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
5 Servo Adjustment
IB-1501229-F 320
6
Spindle Adjustment
321 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
CAUTION
1. Do not adjust when possible risks associated with adjustment procedures are not thoroughly taken into consideration.
2. Be careful when touching rotating section, or your hand may be caught in or cut.
3. Changing of parameters has to be done carefully.
IB-1501229-F 322
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 20480
---Setting range---
1 to 20480
---Setting range---
1 to 8192
---Setting range---
1 to 8192
---Setting range---
1 to 20480
323 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 20480
---Setting range---
1 to 8192
---Setting range---
1 to 8192
(Note) Low-speed coil setting SP081, SP082, SP083 and SP084 are set to "0" when coil changeover specification is not
available.
IB-1501229-F 324
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Set SP001=15
NO
Resonance occurs?
Yes
NO
Is droop oscillation
0.045°p-p or less?
YES
Subtract 3 from SP005 Multiply SP005 by 0.9 Note that the maximum setting value is as follows:
SP005(max) ≤ 150 × inertia ratio
(Inertia ratio:total inertia/motor inertia)
(Example)
Waveform Position droop When inertia rate is double and the determined gain is
for Ref.
0
350, the setting value for SP005 is 315, which is 90%
Adjustment completed of the determined gain, however,the setting value for
0.045°or less
SP005 should be 300, because the maximum setting
0 value is 150×2(inertia rate)=300.
Current feedback
325 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 9999
(4) Adjusting the position loop gain (SP001: PGV non-interpolation mode position loop gain)
After setting the speed gain, in order to perform acceleration/deceleration operation, set the position loop gain
(SP001) by increasing its setting value from 15. When overshooting occurs at the time of acceleration/deceleration
completion, or when oscillation of the q axis current command gets bigger during a set rotation, the position loop
gain is in limit state. Note that standard position loop gain below is set for the setting gain.
CAUTION
Change "Excessive error detection width" (SP053) when "Position loop gain" (SP001) is changed.
Current feedback waveform (Ch2: Current feedback) When oscillation gets bigger
is the limit.
(Example)As the closest value should be selected from the standard setting range shown below, set 47 to SP001
when the limit gain is 55.
---Setting range---
1 to 200 (rad/s)
IB-1501229-F 326
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Output [W]
deceleration time is calculated using the calculation expression which Po
corresponds to each range of the rotation speed for calculation. Note that
Actual
the load torque (friction torque) is not considered in the calculation acceleration/deceleration
expression, so the result may slightly differ from the actual acceleration/ 0
output
deceleration time. 0 N1 N2 N3
Rotation speed [r/min ]
Output characteristics for
(a) Maximum motor output during acceleration/deceleration: Po acceleration/deceleration
The values obtained in (a) and (b) are substituted into the following calculation expressions.
To calculate the acceleration/deceleration time of the rotation speed N (r/min), use the expression (c), (d) or
(e) which is selected depending on the range that corresponds to the speed N.
(c) Acceleration/deceleration time for constant torque range: t1···0 to N [r/min] (0 ≦ N ≦ N1)
(For N>N1, apply N=N1 and also calculate t2 or t3.)
(d) Acceleration/deceleration time for constant output range: t2···N1 to N [r/min] (N1<N ≦ N2)
(For N>N2, apply N=N2 and also calculate t3.)
(e) Acceleration/deceleration time in deceleration output range: t3···N2 to N [r/min] (N2<N ≦ N3)
Based on the above expressions, the acceleration/deceleration time: t from 0 to N3 [r/min] is:
t = t1 + t2 + t3 [s] (Caution 2)
327 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
CAUTION
1. Note that the inertia (J) is a quarter of "GD2".
Ex.) When "GD2" is 0.2 [kg•m2], the inertia is "0.2 / 4 = 0.05 [kg•m2]".
2. If the AC input power voltage to the power supply is low, or if the input power impedance is high, the acceleration/
deceleration time may be long. (Especially, the acceleration/deceleration time of the deceleration output range may be
long.)
3. For the actual measurement in comparison with the theoretical value, perform under the same condition as the
calculated load inertia of Jall. The acceleration/deceleration time differs according to the inertia. When performing the
measurement with a workpiece or tool installed to the spindle, confirm that the acceleration/deceleration time has been
calculated when the total inertia is included in the installed workpiece and tool.
[Calculation example]
Calculate the acceleration/deceleration time from 0 to 10000[r/min] 8.0
for an spindle motor having the output characteristics shown on the
right when the motor inertia is 0.0148 [kg•m2], and when the motor 6.0
Output [kW ]
5.5
shaft conversion load inertia is 0.05 [kg•m2]. 15-minute
rating
4.1
4.0
3.7 2.8
2.0
Po = (Short-time rated output) × 1.2 = 5500 × 1.2 = 6600 [W]
Continuous
rating
0
Jall = (Motor inertia) + (load inertia) 0 1500 6000 10000
-2 2 -2 2
1.097 x 10 x Jall x N1 1.097 x 10 x 0.0648 x 1500
t1 = = = 0.242 [s]
Po 6600
1.097 x 10-2 x Jall x (N22 - N12) 1.097 x 10-2 x 0.0648 x (60002 - 15002)
t2 = = = 1.818 [s]
2Po 26600
1.097 x 10-2 x Jall x (N33 - N23) 1.097 x 10-2 x 0.0648 x (100003 - 60003)
t3 = = = 4.691 [s]
3 x Po x N2 3 x 6600 x 6000
Thus,
t = t1 + t2 + t3 = 0.242 + 1.818 + 4.691 = 6.751 [s]
IB-1501229-F 328
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
When acceleration/deceleration time does not match the theoretical value (an error rate 15% or more), check the
following items.
[1] There may be an error in calculating load inertia for the motor axis conversion used when calculating the
theoretical acceleration/deceleration time. Check the load inertia again.
[2] When acceleration time is long and deceleration time is short, friction torque is thought to be large. Check load
meter value at the maximum speed (spindle monitor screen). If the load is 10% or more, friction torque is
thought to be relatively large. Mechanical friction, such as bearing friction or timing belt friction, is assumed to
be large. Measure the acceleration/deceleration time again following trial run.
[3] Even if the problems above are not found, when acceleration/deceleration time does not match, there may be
a possibility of using spindle motor and spindle drive unit that are not specified, or using wrong parameters.
Check the spindle motor type and spindle drive unit type again, as well as the spindle parameter settings.
POINT
There are cases where acceleration/deceleration waveforms change depending on the spindle temperature.
Check the waveforms when the spindle temperature is high (after continuous operation) and when it is low.
CAUTION
Vibration or sudden acceleration/deceleration may occur during adjustment. When performing measurement with a
workpiece or tool installed, pay careful attention for the safety during adjustment.
329 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 60 (s)
---Setting range---
0 to 30000 (ms)
IB-1501229-F 330
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Speed feedback
Current feedback
Acceleration time
Acceleration waveform
check completed
331 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Speed feedback
Current feedback
IB-1501229-F 332
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Relation between SP071 (variable current limit during deceleration, lower limit value) and
SP072 (variable current limit during deceleration, break point speed)
0
100
q axis command/FB
0
<1>
SP071
<2>
0 Time(s)
SP072 Motor rotation speed <1> SP152(SP184)×SP071/100
SP026 <2> SP152(SP184)
Max. rotation speed
(1) Rotation speed – Decreasing current value curve (2) Rotation speed/current command FB waveform
【#13071】 SP071 DIQM Variable current limit during deceleration, lower limit value
Set this parameter to adjust the deceleration time by changing the current limit value during
deceleration depending on the motor speed.
As shown below, set the lower limit rate of the current limit in SP071 (DIQM), and use with SP072
(DIQN).
When DIQM is set to 100%, the standard current limit value in deceleration (SP152) is applied.
100%
SP152
DIQM
---Setting range---
0 to 999 (%)
【#13072】 SP072 DIQN Variable current limit during deceleration, break point speed
Set this parameter to adjust the deceleration time by changing the current limit value during
deceleration depending on the motor speed.
As shown below, set the lower limit rate of the current limit in SP071 (DIQM), and use with SP072
(DIQN).
When DIQM is set to 100%, the standard current limit value in deceleration (SP152) is applied.
100%
SP152
DIQM
---Setting range---
1 to 32767 (r/min)
333 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
0 0
q axis current command
Current limit range at deceleration
Current edge [1]
q axis current command
(SP152 or SP184)
0 0 Time(s)
Time(s)
Current edge [2]
---Setting range---
1 to 32767 (0.1(r/min)/ms)
IB-1501229-F 334
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Vibration
In-position signal
335 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
-(SP152)
NO
Current edge <
Current control value ?
YES
Ch3:In-position signal
YES
Orientation time
Stop within
= 4.00s- 3.70s = 0.30s<0.4s OK
In-position
POINT
Check the orientation operation with the maximum inertia by installing a workpiece or tool to the spindle head. However, if it
is dangerous to check the operation at the maximum speed, slow down to the safe speed to check.
IB-1501229-F 336
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Adjust orientation time < NC Analyzer setting (Time-series data measurement) >
Get Waveform type
CH1 Speed feedback (r/min)
Set the "Time-series data
measurement" with NC Analyzer
CH2 Current feedback
as shown on the right CH3 Control output 1(bitC) *In-position signal
Screen operation
[1] Press the NC function key DIAGN .
Stop with 180° deviated [2] Press the NC menu key I/F diagn .
(Refer to the right ) [3] Press the NC menu key 1-shot output .
[4] Input “R7009/4650” with the NC key.
[5] Command M19 (orientation stop).
<-Stop at the side opposite to the orientation stop
position (with 180° deviated).
[6] Press the NC menu key 1-shot output .
[7] Input “R7009/0” with the NC key.
Ch1:
Current limit at
Speed feedback acceleration
(SP153 or SP185)
NO Current edge < 0
Current control value?
Ch2:
Current feedback
Current limit at
YES 0 regeneration
(SP152 or SP184)
Increase SP016 by +5
Emergency stop
0
Check the orientation stop time Ch3: standard value
In-position signal 0.4s or less
0
Orientation time
adjustment completed
337 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
[2] Create a NC program so that the synchronous tapping operation program has 3000r/min of spindle rotation
speed, 1mm (equivalent of M6 screw) of screw pitch size, and depths at which the following two different
operation patterns are generated.
(Note that the operation conditions, such as spindle rotation speed and screw pitch, may be specified by the
machine tool builder.)
Operation pattern 1
Time (sec)
Adjust depth so that motor rotation speed waveform shapes trapezoids
Operation pattern 2
Time (sec)
Adjust depth so that motor rotation speed waveform shapes mountain-valley
IB-1501229-F 338
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
[3] Select "Synchronous tapping error measurement" on NC Analyzer, and perform synchronous tapping
operations with the operation pattern 2 above.
*The following measurement data of servo and spindle are automatically set when "Synchronous tapping error
measurement" is selected.
[4] Check the waveform and adjust the synchronous tapping time constant so that the margin for current limit at
acceleration/deceleration is 50% or more.
[3] If the number of error pulse is 100 (p-p) or less, satisfactory accuracy is secured, and the check is completed.
[4] If the number of error pulse exceeds 100, increase SP008 (VGN2) by 10 increments, and adjust so that the
error pulse is 100 or less. Note that the maximum setting value is 150 × [inertia ratio].
339 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 200 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
1 to 9999
---Setting range---
1 to 9999
---Setting range---
0 to 32767
IB-1501229-F 340
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Synchronous tapping
in G68 When any one of three base axes cannot satisfy the above specifications, this function cannot be used in
(3-dimensional G68.
coordinate conversion)
(Note) When synchronous tapping is performed under conditions that high-speed synchronous tapping function
cannot be used, operation continues without compensation. During synchronous tapping, the status can be
confirmed with bit8 in spindle control command output 6. (0: Disabled, 1: Enabled)
341 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
[1] NC parameter
High-speed synchronous tapping function is an option. Check the machine specifications when adjusting the
parameters.
【#1281(PR)】 ext17
---Setting range---
0 to 99999 (r/min)
---Setting range---
1 to 5000 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 99999 (r/min)
---Setting range---
1 to 5000 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 99999 (r/min)
---Setting range---
1 to 5000 (ms)
IB-1501229-F 342
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 100(%)
(Note) The inclination of linear acceleration/deceleration control for multi-step synchronous tapping is determined by the
ratio of "rotation speed" to "acceleration/deceleration time constant". When using multi-step synchronous tapping,
the inclination should be set so that the 1st step is higher than the second step, and the second step is higher than
the third step. When the inclination of the latter step is higher, the multi-step setting is disabled and the inclination of
the former step is applied.
---Setting range---
-100 to 100 (Stall current %)
For linear motor, set the gross mass of the moving sections in kg unit.
---Setting range---
For general motor: 0 to 5000 (%)
For linear motor: 0 to 5000 (kg)
343 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
0 to 2000 (1/μm)
[Spindle]
---Setting range---
0 to 2000 (1/μm)
(Note 1) When adjusting high-speed synchronous tapping, SV032: Torque offset and SV037: Load inertia scale need to be
set.
(Note 2) The following are the parameters for adjusting. When turning ON the NC power supply again with these parameters
set, an initial parameter error alarm 37 occurs.
- Machine error compensation amount disable setting SV113 bit7 = 1
- Load display selection SP228 bit0-2 = 110, 111
IB-1501229-F 344
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Base value
- The base value of synchronous errors is 8.8° or less during M6 and PIT1 machining.
(The conventional base value of 100 pulses or less is based on 4096 pulses per rotation, therefore
100 [pulse]/4096 [pulse] × 360 [°] ≒ 8.8 [°])
- As shown in the figure below, a synchronous error may become larger due to lost motion of a servo
axis etc. when starting tapping or during velocity reversal at the hole bottom. At the start, the work is
not within cutting range so it will not be affected. When this error is large, adjust the servo axes with
lost motion compensation etc.
0
Synchronous
error
- When torque saturation is released, synchronous errors may become larger. There is no problem if
the synchronous error is the same or smaller than the base value. If the error is large, it can be
improved by increasing the time constant or lowering the synchronous tapping position gain of the
spindle.
345 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Start (Note 1)
High-speed synchronous tapping-related parameter settings
[NC]
# 1281/bit5: High-speed synchronous tapping enabled
Check that the parameters related to high-speed [Servo]
synchronous tapping function are set. SV032: Torque offset
SV037: Load inertia scale
SV129: Synchronous control feed forward filter frequency
SV244: Communication interpolation unit for
Enable high-speed synchronous tapping communication among drive units
SP226/bit3=1 [Spindle]
SP244: Communication interpolation unit for
communication among drive units
Disable machine error compensation amount
Set "1" to SV113/bit7 Setting for checking synchronous error during adjustment
Disabled during adjustment because backlash and pitch error change the
synchronous error waveforms.
#3013 (stap1) to #3016 (stap4)
Measure acceleration/deceleration time of
maximum tapping rotation speed.
(Note 2)
Parameter/Time constant
adjustment
Synchronous tapping
waveform check
Synchronous error waveform within judgement value?
No speed overshooting at stop?
No vibration of torque current command NO
at stop?
Set a value of about 1.1 times of the time constant
where a speed overshoot or a current vibration does
YES not occur at stop.
(Note 3)
Finish
CAUTION
1. Perform the high-speed synchronous tapping function adjustment after servo adjustment.
2. Use NC Analyzer2 to check the synchronous tapping waveforms. The displayed value of the load meter is the torque
current command.
3. Make sure to change the load display (SP228 bit0 to 2) back to the initial setting value and disable the machine error
compensation amount (SV113 bit7=0) after high-speed synchronous tapping adjustment. Failure to observe this causes
initial parameter error alarm 37 to occur after turning the NC power supply ON again.
IB-1501229-F 346
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
347 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
0.010° or less
0 Ch2: Current command
0.010° or less
0 Ch2: Current command
[2] When satisfactory accuracy is not secured, increase SP008 (VGN2) by 10 increments and adjust so that the
accuracy level meets the standard. Note that the maximum setting value is 150 x [inertia ratio].
SP034 bit3=0 bit2=0 bit1=0 bit3=0 bit2=1 bit1=0 bit3=1 bit2=0 bit1=0
Notch filter 1 Depth setting Setting value: XXX0 Setting value: XXX4 Setting value: XXX8
SP038
2000(Hz) to 400(Hz) 399(Hz) to 200(Hz) 190(Hz) or lower
Notch filter 1 Setting frequency
Set 800 to SP038 and XXX0 to SP034. Measure position droop and current command at this time, and adjust notch
filter's frequency and depth so that the position droop is within standard range.
IB-1501229-F 348
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
POINT
1. When incorrect frequency is set, suddenly resonance can occur and big abnormal noise can be generated. Input the
appropriate value.
2. Do not set the value to low-frequency (50Hz).
---Setting range---
1 to 200 (rad/s)
---Setting range---
1 to 9999
---Setting range---
1 to 9999
---Setting range---
0 to 32767
349 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
IB-1501229-F 350
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (Hz)
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (Hz)
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (Hz)
---Setting range---
0 to 5000 (Hz)
351 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
(Note1) To change the setting value of SP003, set the synchronous and basic spindles to the same value.
(Note2) For the adjustment of SP005, SP006 and SP007, conduct "Adjusting the speed loop parameter" as
a single unit beforehand.
[2] Set rotation speed and time constant during acceleration/deceleration figured by theoretical calculations.
[3] Set "Time-series data measurement" with NC Analyzer as follows and output speed feedback and current
command.
Speed feedback
Current command
0
IB-1501229-F 352
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
1 to 200 (rad/s)
353 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Deceleration
Deceleration Stop
Coast
Deceleratie using
low-speed coil
After the elapse of maximum delay time, Because of the changeover to high-speed coil,
the motor cannot stop but caost deceleration finishes in time and the motor stops
【#13055】 SP055 EMGx Max. gate off delay time after emergency stop
Set the time required to forcibly execute READY OFF after the emergency stop is input.
Normally set to "5000".
When 5000ms or more is set for deceleration time constant at emergency stop (SP056), set the
same value as SP056.
When using the power backup system (MDS-D/DH-PFU) and setting the value of this parameter to
5000ms or more, a communication error between NC and drive unit may occur when power restarts
after a instantaneous power interrupt.
It is not a problem so turn the NC power ON again to start up.
When "0" is set, 7000ms is the actual value to be set.
---Setting range---
0 to 29900 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 29900 (ms)
IB-1501229-F 354
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
S command
Motor speed
Speed FB
㻌
Conventional
High-response
Time
0
Delay time
2/posotion control gain[s]
Current command
Time
0
Comparison of spindle
acceleration/deceleration by S command
---Setting range---
0 to 10000 (0.01%)
POINT
This function is invalid during orientation and interpolation control (spindle synchronous/C axis/synchronous tapping
control) even when it is set.
355 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Torque
characteristics
Torque for the command speed>Maximum torque
Set the feed amount Torque
according to the spindle
rotation Max. torque
(2)
Spindle Cutting torque (1) Heavy cutting start
(1) (2) Machining at a lowered speed
Cutter
(3) Normal cutting
(3)
Workpiece 0 Speed
Alarm23 area
0 Time
Controls so that the cutting torque is
maintained and the finished surface has even
Feed axis speed
cut marks.
0 Time
---Setting range---
-1,0 to 100(%)
IB-1501229-F 356
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
NC
MDS-E/EH-SP
Connect to CN2
Temperature detection
Output compensation
Built-in thermistor
(Analog signal)
Motor-end encoder
(Serial communication)
Spindle motor
357 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
CAUTION
Check the monitor screen to make sure that the motor has reached the maximum rotation speed in constant output during
execution of the created program.
* "Maximum rotation speed in constant output" is the maximum speed at which the short-time rated output will not drop
lower than the motor’s specified output. (Refer to the motor output specifications.)
If the machine’s specified speed is lower than the motor’s maximum speed in constant output, the machine’s specified
speed serves as the maximum rotation speed.
IB-1501229-F 358
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
< How to adjust the spindle motor temperature compensation function >
YES
For the initial operation after setting SP226/bit8 = 1,
Stop the spindle (servo OFF)
make sure to perform acceleration/deceleration that
reaches the maximum rotation speed in constant output.
Decrement SP235(R2H) by 5
* The lower limit of setting is 100.
[AFLT gain(dB)] on the NO
spindle monitor is ≦ 110? * If you reduce SP235(R2H) too much, excessive
compensation will result and [AFLT gain (dB)] will be too
YES high. In this case increment the setting by 5.
Increment SP235(R2H) by 5
YES
359 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
Set SP236(WIH)=10
Increment SP236(R2H) by 2
YES
Change SP226(SFNC6) from 0100
to 0000 (display the temperature
compensation adjustment indicator)
Finish
CAUTION
1. Carry out the adjustment within the motor’s specified ambient temperature range (0 to +40°C).
2. This function is unavailable if the time taken to accelerate to the maximum speed in constant output is shorter than 0.1[s].
Make sure to perform such acceleration/deceleration that reaches the maximum rotation speed in constant output.
3. If you program a command for accelerating up to the maximum speed in constant output, insert a dwell time so that the
spindle motor can reach the maximum speed.
4. Do not use this function for a spindle motor if it has a direct cooling system on the secondary side (rotor).
5. Before starting the adjustment, make sure that [Temperature (°C)] on the spindle monitor is close to the room
temperature.
If [Temperature (°C)] is unchanged or any error is found during the adjustment, do not use this function.
6. Do not change the spindle motor cooling condition after the parameter adjustment for this function is complete.
Also make sure to change SP226(SFNC6)/bit8 back to 0.
IB-1501229-F 360
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
---Setting range---
0 to 400 (%)
---Setting range---
0 to 150 (min)
361 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
<Operation>
When an emergency stop occurs, the motor will decelerate at the same inclination from each speed.
SP056
Constant inclination
Motor speed deceleration
Time
(Note) If the setting value of SP056 is longer than the value of SP055, the motor will coast.
【#13055】 SP055 EMGx Max. gate off delay time after emergency stop
Set the time required to forcibly execute READY OFF after the emergency stop is input.
Normally set to "5000".
When 5000ms or more is set for deceleration time constant at emergency stop (SP056), set the
same value as SP056.
When using the power backup system (MDS-D/DH-PFU) and setting the value of this parameter to
5000ms or more, a communication error between NC and drive unit may occur when power restarts
after a instantaneous power interrupt.
It is not a problem so turn the NC power ON again to start up.
When "0" is set, 7000ms is the actual value to be set.
---Setting range---
0 to 29900 (ms)
---Setting range---
0 to 29900 (ms)
IB-1501229-F 362
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
bit Details
0 RDY READY ON command
1 SRV Servo ON command
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 ALMR Alarm reset command
8 TL1 Torque limit 1 selection command
9 TL2 Torque limit 2 selection command
A TL3 Torque limit 3 selection command
B - (For maintenance)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
363 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
bit Details
0 - (For maintenance)
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 - (For maintenance)
8 - (For maintenance)
9 SSW Speed monitor command valid
A NCDC In door closed (controller)
B SRVDC In door closed (all drive units)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
bit Details
0 SC1 Spindle control mode selection command 1
1 SC2 Spindle control mode selection command 2
2 SC3 Spindle control mode selection command 3
3 - (For maintenance)
4 GKC Gear changeover command
5 GR1 Gear selection command 1
6 GR2 Gear selection command 2
7 - (For maintenance)
8 - (For maintenance)
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B - (For maintenance)
C - (For maintenance)
D LCS L coil selection command
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
IB-1501229-F 364
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
[1] Drive unit operation mode can be selected with the bit correspondences below.
[2] Mode changeover is valid during in-position (INP=1) or other than during droop cancel / phase
compensation (DCSL=PCMP=0).
Operation mode
SC3 SC2 SC1
Conventional method New method
0 0 0 Speed/orientation control Non interpolation control
0 0 1 Spindle synchronization Spindle synchronization
0 1 0 C-axis control
Interpolation control
1 0 0 Synchronous tapping control
(Note) When selecting bits other than above, control mode error (4E) occurs.
[3] Continuity cannot be guaranteed for the value of position FB in non-interpolation mode. (Position may be
skipped for multiple rotations due to droop cancel or phase compensation.)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
365 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
bit Details
0 - (For maintenance)
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 - (For maintenance)
8 - (For maintenance)
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B PY2 Minimum excitation rate 2 changeover request
C VG2 Speed gain set 2 changeover request
D ORC Zero point re-detection request
E TLUP Increase holding power of spindle
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
IB-1501229-F 366
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
bit Details
0 OMRFF OMR-FF control request
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 - (For maintenance)
8 DD1 Drivers communication control request
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B - (For maintenance)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
367 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
bit Details
0 RDY In ready ON
1 SRV In servo ON
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 ALMR In alarm
8 TL1 In torque limit 1 selection
9 TL2 In torque limit 2 selection
A TL3 In torque limit 3 selection
B - (For maintenance)
C INP In in-position
D LMT In torque limit
E - (For maintenance)
F WRN In warning
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
IB-1501229-F 368
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
bit Details
0 ZCN Z phase passed
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 ZS In zero speed
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 EXEMG In external emergency stop
8 - (For maintenance)
9 SSW In speed monitor
A NCDC In door closed (controller)
B SRVDC In door closed (self drive unit)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
+ 15r/min
Motor speed
200ms
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
369 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
bit Details
0 SC1 In spindle control mode selection 1
1 SC2 In spindle control mode selection 2
2 SC3 In spindle control mode selection 3
3 - (For maintenance)
4 GKC In gear changeover command
5 GR1 In gear selection 1
6 GR2 In gear selection 2
7 MPN Magnetic pole position not set
8 - (For maintenance)
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B -
(For maintenance)
C -
(For maintenance)
D LCS In L coil selection
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
IB-1501229-F 370
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
bit Details
0 - (For maintenance)
1 MD Speed detection
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 MKC In coil changeover
7 - (For maintenance)
8 - (For maintenance)
9 SD2 2nd speed detection
A - (For maintenance)
B PY2 In minimum excitation rate 2 selection
C VG2 In speed gain set 2 selection
D ORF Zero point re-detection request
E - (For maintenance)
F INP2 In 2nd in-position
Speed Speed
SD signal detection detection
OFF ON
371 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
6 Spindle Adjustment
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
Name Details
Spindle control output 6
F E D C B A 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
DD1 OMRFF
bit Details
0 OMRFF In OMR-FF control
1 - (For maintenance)
2 - (For maintenance)
3 - (For maintenance)
4 - (For maintenance)
5 - (For maintenance)
6 - (For maintenance)
7 - (For maintenance)
8 DD1 In drivers communication control
9 - (For maintenance)
A - (For maintenance)
B - (For maintenance)
C - (For maintenance)
D - (For maintenance)
E - (For maintenance)
F - (For maintenance)
(Note) The bits other than those above are used for maintenance.
IB-1501229-F 372
7
Troubleshooting
373 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
CAUTION
1. This power supply unit uses a large capacity electrolytic capacitor. When the CHARGE lamp on the front of the power
supply unit is lit, voltage is still present at the PN terminal (TE2). Do not touch the terminal block in this state.
2. Before replacing the unit, etc., always confirm that there is no voltage at the PN terminal (TE2) with a tester or wait at
least 15 minutes after turning the main power OFF.
3. The conductivity in the unit cannot be checked.
4. Never carry out a megger test on the drive unit or power supply unit as the unit could be damaged.
POINT
When the drive unit of E/EH Series which uses two cooling fans is in an emergency stop or alarm, one of fans (upper one in
the case of vertical layout, or either one in the case of horizontal layout) is stopped and power-saving operation is
performed. If the suspended fan is restarted by canceling the emergency stop, it is not a problem with the fan.
IB-1501229-F 374
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
F1 E7 F2 9F Not lit
F+axis No. Warning No. F+axis No. Warning No.
LED display
375 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 376
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
377 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 378
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
379 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
AT343 Mitsutoyo Initialization EEPROM er- Photoelec- ROM/RAM CPU error Photoelec- Static capaci- Photoelec-
AT543 error ror tric type, stat- error tric type over- ty type error tric type error
AT545 ic capacity speed
AT1143 type data
ST748 mismatch
LC195M, HEIDENHAIN Initialization EEPROM er- Relative/ab- ROM/RAM CPU error Overspeed Absolute po- Relative po-
LC495M, error ror solute posi- error sition data er- sition data er-
LC291M, tion data ror ror
LIC2197M, mismatch
LIC2199M
MC15
RCN2590M,
RCN5390M,
RCN5590M,
RCN8390M
ROC425M,
ROC2390M
ECA4000Series
EIB Series
MPRZ scale Mitsubishi Installation - Detection po- Scale break- Absolute po- - Gain fault Phase fault
Heavy Indus- accuracy sition devi- ing sition detec-
tries Machine fault ance tion fault
Tool
SR67A, Magnescale Laser diode System Encoder mis- - - Over speed Absolute po- Relative po-
SR75, SR85 error memory error match error sition data er- sition data er-
SR74, SR77 ror ror
SR84, SR87
RU77
RS87
SAM/SVAM/ FAGOR - - Absolute val- H/W error CPU error - - -
GAM/LAM/HAM ue detection
Series error
RL40N/RA Renishaw Initialization - Absolute po- - - Over speed - -
Series error sition data er-
ror
WMFA/WMBA/ AMO Initialization - Relative/ab- - - Over speed Absolute po- -
WMRA/LMFA/ error solute posi- sition data er-
LMBA Series tion data ror
(Note) mismatch
AMS-ABS-3B Schneeberger - - - Absolute po- - - - -
Series sition data er-
ror
(Note) A drive unit processes all reset types of alarms as "PR". However, "AR" will be applied according to the encoder.
IB-1501229-F 380
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
EIB Series HEIDENHAIN Initialization EEPROM er- - - CPU error Overspeed - Relative po-
error ror sition data er-
ror
ADB-K70M Mitsubishi Installation - Detection po- Scale break- - - Gain fault Phase fault
Heavy Indus- accuracy sition devi- ing
tries Machine fault ance
Tool
GEL2449M LE- Waveform Analog sig- EEPROM er- Power volt- H/W error Overspeed Count error Overheat
NORD+BAU- error nal warning ror age warning warning warning
ER
(Note) A drive unit processes all reset types of alarms as "PR". However, "AR" will be applied according to the encoder.
381 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
(Note) Resetting method may be "PR" depending on the sub-number in the decimal place.
IB-1501229-F 382
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
383 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
(Note 1) If a power supply alarm (60 to 77) occurs, all servos will stop with the dynamic brakes, and all spindles will coast to a stop.
(Note 2) "b", "C" and "d" displayed on the power supply unit's LED as a solid light (not flickering) do not indicate an alarm.
(Note 3) Check the LED display of the power backup unit to identify what alarm is occurring to the power backup unit.
**Refer to "9.5.2 List of Power Backup Function Alarms".
(Note 4) When the power supply alarm (6F) is detected in the 2nd part system, the reset method differs depending on the detected
power supply alarm.
IB-1501229-F 384
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
385 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 386
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
7.3 Troubleshooting
Follow this section to troubleshoot the alarms that occur during start up or while the machine is operating. If the state is
not improved with the following investigations, the drive unit may be faulty. Exchange the unit with another unit of the
same capacity, and check whether the state is improved.
LED
Symptom Cause of occurrence Investigation method Remedy
display
The drive unit axis No. setting is Is there any other drive unit that has the same
Set correctly.
Initial communication with the incorrect. axis No. set?
AA CNC was not completed The CNC setting is incorrect. Is the No. of CNC controlled axes correct? Set correctly.
correctly. Communication with CNC is Is the connector (CN1A, CN1B) connected? Connect correctly.
incorrect. Is the cable broken? Replace the cable.
The axis is not used, the setting is
Is the DIP switch set correctly? Set correctly.
Initial communication with the for use inhibiting.
Ab
CNC was not carried out. Communication with CNC is Is the connector (CN1A, CN1B) connected? Connect correctly.
incorrect. Is the cable broken? Replace the cable.
Check the repeatability. Replace the unit.
An error was detected in the
The CPU peripheral circuit is Improve the
12 unit's memory and IC during the Check whether there is any abnormality with
abnormal. surrounding
self-diagnosis at power ON. the unit's surrounding environment, etc.
environment.
The drive unit has started up normally if the following type of emergency stop (E7) is displayed on the display unit's LED
display.
F1 E7 F2 E7 Not lit
F+axis No. Emergency stop F+axis No. Emergency stop
387 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 388
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
389 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 390
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
391 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 392
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
393 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 394
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
Overspeed
Alarm No.
The motor was detected to rotate at a speed exceeding the allowable speed (In the case of linear motor, it was detected to move
31
at a speed exceeding the allowable speed).
Investigation details Investigation results Remedies SV SP
Check if the unit in which the alarm was detected is The alarm was detected in servo. Check the investigation item No. 2.
1 ◯ ◯
servo or spindle. The alarm was detected in spindle. Check the investigation item No. 3.
Check the servo parameters SV001 (PC1), SV002 The settings are incorrect. Correctly set.
2 ◯
(PC2), SV018 (PIT) and SV025 (MTYP) settings. Correctly set. Check the investigation item No. 5.
The setting is incorrect.
Correctly set.
3 Check the spindle parameter SP026 (TSP) setting. The alarm is detected at 115% of SP026. ◯
Correctly set. Check the investigation item No. 4.
There is a problem. Adjust the PLG output waveform.
4 Check the PLG output waveform. ◯ ◯
Normal. Check the investigation item No. 5.
Increase the acceleration/ deceleration time
The waveform is overshooting. constant.
Lower the load inertia.
Check whether the speed waveform is
5 Check if there is any abnormality in the unit's ◯ ◯
overshooting.
ambient environment.
The waveform is not overshooting.
(Ex.: Ambient temperature, noise, grounding)
Check the investigation item No. 6.
[1] The alarm occurs when the motor is
stopped.
Replace the encoder or encoder cable.
6 Check the repeatability. [2] The rotation speed displayed on the drive ◯ ◯
monitor varies when the motor is stopped.
The alarm occurs at all time. Replace the drive unit.
395 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 396
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
397 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 398
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
Feedback error 3
Alarm No.
Either a missed feedback pulse in the main side incremental encoder or an error in the Z-phase was detected in the full closed
41
loop system. In the servo, Z-phase was not detected by a rotary encoder within 2 rotations.
Investigation details Investigation results Remedies SV SP
The cable is disconnected. Replace the cable.
Check the connection condition of the cable and Check for dirt on the connector terminal and
The cable is normal.
1 encoder. reconnect it. ◯ ◯
- Check if the cable is disconnected. The alarm occurs even after it is
Replace the encoder.
reconnected.
Feedback error 1
Alarm No.
An error was detected in the sub side encoder (feedback signals of the position encoder in a servo system, or PLG's feedback
42
signals in a spindle system).
Investigation details Investigation results Remedies SV SP
Parameter is set incorrectly. Correctly set.
1 Check SP019 and SP020. ◯
Parameter is set correctly. Check the investigation item No. 2.
2 Check the alarm No. "2C" items. ◯
399 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 400
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
401 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 402
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
Overload 2
Alarm No. Current command of more than 95% of the unit's max. current was being continuously given for longer than 1 second in a servo
51 system. In a spindle system, current command of more than 95% of the motor's max. current was being continuously given for
longer than 1 second.
Investigation details Investigation results Remedies SV SP
The alarm occurred after ready ON before
Investigate item 2.
1 Did the alarm occur immediately after READY ON? operation starts. ◯
The alarm occurred after normal operation. Investigate item 5.
Check that the PN voltage is supplied to the drive The CHARGE lamp becomes dark. Increase the capacity of power supply.
unit. L+ or L- screw was loosened. Tighten the L+ and L- screws.
2 MDS-EJ/EJH Series is not connected to the power ◯
supply unit, so investigate item 3 for MDS-EJ/EJH. Approx. 300V is correctly supplied. Investigate item 3.
[1] Is the CHARGE lamp ON?
Check the motor power cable (U, V, W phases). The connections are incorrect.
Connect correctly.
[1] The power cable is not connected. Connected to the incorrect axis.
3 ◯
[2] Is the cable connected to the motor for another
The connections are correct. Investigate item 4.
axis?
Check the encoder cable connection. The connections are incorrect. Connect correctly.
4 [1] Is the cable connected to the motor for another ◯
The connections are correct. Investigate item 5.
axis?
Check the machining program and soft limit
The machine has collided.
5 Check whether the machine has collided. settings. ◯
The machine has not collided. Investigate item 6.
The current is saturated during acceleration/ Increase the acceleration/ deceleration time
Check whether the current value on the NC Servo
deceleration. constant.
6 Monitor screen is saturated during acceleration/ ◯
The current value during acceleration/
deceleration. Investigate item 7.
deceleration is appropriate.
Replace the encoder.
The Feedback signal is abnormal.
(With the absolute position system, the zero
7 Check the encoder Feedback. - The droop does not stabilize. ◯
point must be established.)
The Feedback signal is normal. Replace the drive unit.
The value is large. Lower the load.
8 Check the load meter value. ◯
The value is normal. Investigate item 9.
Check the PLG output waveform. There is a problem. Adjust the PLG output waveform.
9 ◯
For TS5690, waveform cannot be checked. Normal Replace the drive unit.
403 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
Supplement (servo)
Depending on the ideal machine position in respect to the command position, the actual machine
position could enter the actual shaded section shown below, which is separated more than the
distance set in OD1.
Position
Command position
OD1
Ideal machine position
OD2
OD2
OD1
Time
Servo OFF Servo ON
IB-1501229-F 404
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
(Note) For a spindle, the error is detected only during the spindle/C axis control.
Collision detection 1: G0
Alarm No.
When collision detection function (set to SV060) was valid, the disturbance torque in rapid traverse (G0) exceeded the collision
58
detection level.
Investigation details Investigation results Remedies SV SP
A collision has occurred at the table, turret or
Check the machining program and soft limit
spindle head in the machine during
settings.
movement.
Check whether the machine has collided during G0
1 Adjust the tolerable disturbance torque ◯
operation. There is no collision at the table, turret and
SV060.
spindle head in the machine during
(Note) Set the detection level to be 1.5 times
movement
or more of the maximum torque.
(Note) When the disturbance torque exceeds the collision detection level, the motor will decelerate to a stop with a torque
80% (standard) value of the motor's maximum torque. After decelerating to a stop, the alarm will occur.
Collision detection 1: G1
Alarm No.
When collision detection function was valid (SV035.c1G1 was set), the disturbance torque in cutting feed (G1) exceeded the
59
collision detection level.
Investigation details Investigation results Remedies SV SP
Check the machining program and soft limit
The machine has collided during movement.
settings.
Increase the detection level (SV035. clG1).
Check whether the machine has collided during G0
1 G1 collision detection level ◯
operation.
The machine has not collided. =SV060×c1G1(001 to 111)
(Note) Set the detection level larger than the
maximum cutting load.
(Note) When the disturbance torque exceeds the collision detection level, the motor will decelerate to a stop with a torque
80% (standard) value of the motor's maximum torque. After decelerating to a stop, the alarm will occur.
405 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 406
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
407 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 408
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
409 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 410
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
411 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 412
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
413 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 414
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
415 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 416
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
If an error No. in the following table is displayed as the error parameter No. even when the parameter is set to a value
within the setting range, an error is occurring due to the hardware compatibility or specifications or in relation to several
other parameters. Check the specifications of the servo and spindle system and the descriptions in the following table to
correctly set the parameters.
Error parameter
Details Related parameters
No.
The motor selected is of a motor series different from the drive unit’s input voltage (200V/400V).
2217 SV017
Or a motor of an incompatible motor series is selected.
-In a semi-closed loop control system, the setting value of SV019 is different from that of SV020. Set them
2219 to the same value. SV019
-SV019 is set to a value outside the setting range.
-The resolution of the motor side encoder actually connected is not consistent with the setting value for
2220 SV020. SV020
-SV020 is set to a value outside the setting range.
Incompatible motor type is selected. The machine side encoder type or the motor side encoder type is
SV017, SV025
incorrectly set.
For the speed command synchronous control system with MDS-E/EH-V2/V3,
-The L axis for the drive unit is set as the secondary axis. Set the M axis as the secondary axis. SV025
-The motor side encoders for the L axis and the M axis are different. Use encoders of the same specifications.
For the distance-coded reference scale system,
2225
-When a HEIDENHAIN serial conversion interface unit is connected, the encoder type setting is different from
the connected unit type.
SV018, SV025, SV130
-When a HEIDENHAIN serial conversion interface unit with the rotary type is connected, the ball screw pitch
SV131
(SV018) is set to a value other than "360".
-The speed command synchronous control and the distance-coded reference scale connection are set
concurrently.
2228 The magnetic pole shift amount (SV028) is set for a general servo motor (not a built-in motor). SV028
The vertical axis pull up function (SV033/bitE) is set in the following conditions:
-when the vertical axis pull up direction is not set (SV032=0)
SV032, SV033, SV048
2233 -when the drop prevention function is not set (SV048=0)
SV095
The vertical axis pull up function (SV033/bitE) is not set in the following condition:
-when the vertical axis pull up distance is set (SV095 ≠ 0)
Parallel connection is set when the motor is not a linear servo motor.
Or the DC excitation mode (SV034/bit4) is set in the following conditions:
2234 SV034
-when the NC is powered ON
-when a general servo motor (not a built-in motor) is used.
417 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
Error parameter
Details Related parameters
No.
For the MDS-E/EH Series:
The power supply type (SV036) is set but a power supply unit is not connected.
Always set the power supply type for the drive unit connected last on the NC optical communication cable.
2236 For the MDS-EM/EMH Series: SV036
Do not set the power supply type. It is set from the spindle side.
For the MDS-EJ/EJH Series:
The selected regenerative resistor is not supported in the drive unit of this capacity.
When the DC excitation mode (SV034/bit4) is set, the initial DC excitation level (SV061) is set to a value
2261 SV034, SV061
outside the setting range.
When the DC excitation mode (SV034/bit4) is set, the final DC excitation level (SV062) is set to a value
2262 SV034, SV062
outside the setting range.
When the DC excitation mode (SV034/bit4) is set, the initial DC excitation time (SV063) is set to a value
2263 SV034, SV063
outside the setting range.
-When the distance-coded reference scale (SV081/bit3) is set, the base reference mark interval (SV130) or
the auxiliary reference mark interval (SV131) is not set. SV025, SV081, SV130
2281
-When a HEIDENHAIN serial conversion interface unit is connected, the reference mark is set to be checked SV131
at 3 points (SV081/bit7=1).
With a multiple-axis drive unit, the digital signal input selection (SV082/bitF-C) is set to a different value for
2282 SV082
each axis in the same unit.
-The expansion sub side encoder resolution (SV117) is set to "0" for an encoder that requires the resolution
expansion setting.
2317 If the upper 16 bits for the encoder resolution are 0, this should be set to "-1". SV019,SV025,SV117
-The expansion sub side encoder resolution (SV117) is set to a value other than "0" for an encoder that does
not support the resolution expansion setting.
-The expansion main side encoder resolution (SV118) is set to "0" for an encoder that requires the resolution
expansion setting.
2318 If the upper 16 bits for the encoder resolution are 0, this should be set to "-1". SV020,SV025,SV118
-The expansion main side encoder resolution (SV118) is set to a value other than "0" for an encoder that
does not support the resolution expansion setting.
-The relation between the base reference mark interval (SV130) and the auxiliary reference mark interval
(SV131) is invalid.
-The base reference mark interval (SV130) is set to "0" when a distance-coded reference scale is connected. SV018, SV025, SV130
2330
-The base reference mark interval (SV130) is set to a value other than "0" when a distance-coded reference SV131
scale is not connected.
-The base reference mark interval (SV130) is set to a value other than "0" when the semi-closed loop is set .
-The auxiliary reference mark interval (SV131) is not set when a distance-coded reference scale is
connected.
2331 SV130, SV131
-The auxiliary reference mark interval (SV131) is set to a value other than "0" when a distance-coded
reference scale is not connected.
The distance-coded reference check / revolution counter (SV134) is set to a value other than "0" when the
2334 SV081, SV134
distance-coded reference scale is not set (SV081/bit3=0).
- In the distance-coded reference scale system, the distance-coded reference check /position within one
rotation High (SV135) is set to a value outside the motor side encoder's data range.
2335 SV081, SV135, SV136
- The distance-coded reference check /position within one rotation High (SV135) is set to a value other than
"0" when the distance-coded reference scale is not set (SV081/bit3=0).
The distance-coded reference check /position within one rotation Low (SV136) is set to a value other than
2336 SV081, SV136
"0" when the distance-coded reference scale is not set (SV081/bit3=0).
The distance-coded reference check allowable width (SV137) is set to a value other than "0" when the
2337 SV081, SV137
distance-coded reference scale is not set (SV081/bit3=0).
The safety observation safety speed (SV238) and the safety observation safety motor speed (SV239) dot not
satisfy the following equation.
(Round down the first decimal place. When the calculation results in "0", set SV239 to 1.)
2438 SV238,SV239
SV238 : SSCFEED SV002 : PC2
× = SV239 : SSCRPM
SV018 : PIT SV001 : PC1
The safety observation safety motor speed (SV239) is set to a value greater the overspeed detection motor
2439 SV239
speed.
2450 The base reference mark interval in the distance-coded reference scale is invalid. SV019,SV117,SV130
The absolute position detection is enabled when an incremental encoder is connected as an position
2454 SV025, #2049
encoder.
The following settings are overflowing:
SV001,SV002,SV003,SV0
-Electronic gear
2455 18SV019,SV020,SV049,S
-Position loop gain
V117SV118
-Conversion from the speed detection unit to position detection unit
IB-1501229-F 418
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
Error parameter
Details Related parameters
No.
The motor selected is of a motor series different from the drive unit's input voltage (200V/400V).
13017 SP017
Or a motor of an incompatible motor series is selected.
For the MDS-E/EH Series:
The power supply type (SP032) is set, but a power supply unit is not connected.
Always set the power supply type for the drive unit connected last on the NC optical communication cable.
13032 For the MDS-EM/EMH Series: SP032
Set SP032 to 0019(normal setting), or 0059 (external emergency stop function).
For the MDS-EJ/EJH Series:
The selected regenerative resistor is not supported in the drive unit of this capacity.
-The expansion sub side encoder resolution (SP097) is set to "0" for an encoder that requires the resolution
expansion setting.
13097 If the upper 16 bits for the encoder resolution are "0", this should be set to "-1". SP019,SP031,SP097
-The expansion sub side encoder resolution (SP097) is set to a value other than "0" for an encoder that does
not support the resolution expansion setting.
-The expansion main side encoder resolution (SP098) is set to "0" for an encoder that requires the resolution
expansion setting.
13098 If the upper 16 bits for the encoder resolution are 0, this should be set to "-1". SP020,SP031,SP098
-The expansion main side encoder resolution (SP098) is set to a value other than "0" for an encoder that
does not support the resolution expansion setting.
When the DC excitation mode (SP225/bit4) is set, the initial DC excitation level (SP125) is set to a value
13125 SP225, SP125
outside the setting range.
When the DC excitation mode (SP225/bit4) is set, the final DC excitation level (SP126) is set to a value
13126 SP225, SP126
outside the setting range.
When the DC excitation mode (SP225/bit4) is set, the initial DC time (SP127) is set to a value outside the
13127 SP225, SP127
setting range.
-The pulse application time for an IPM spindle motor is excessive. Set the pulse application time (SP142) to
a value lower than 350μs. SP017,SP018,SP142,
13142
-The coil switch function is disabled and the pulse application coil for an IPM spindle motor is set to the low- SP226
speed coil. Set the pulse application coil to the high-speed coil, or enable the coil switch function.
The DC excitation mode (SP225/bit4) has been set before the axis passes the Z phase. Set the DC excitation
13225 SP225
mode after the axis passes the Z phase.
The safety observation safety speed (SP238) and the safety observation safety motor speed (SP239) do not
satisfy the following equation:
(Round down the first decimal place. When the calculation results in "0", set SP239 to 1.)
13238 SP238,SP239
SP238 : SSCFEED SP057 : GRA1
× = SP239 : SSCRPM
360 SP061 : GRB1
The safety observation safety motor speed calculated from the actual gear ratio exceeds the overspeed
detection motor speed.
(Note) The safety observation safety motor speed calculated from the actual gear ratio
13239 SP239
= SP238:SSCFEED / 360 × PC2 / PC1
PC2: Spindle side gear ratio (SP057 to SP060)
PC1: Motor side gear ratio (SP061 to SP064)
The following settings are overflowing: SP057 to SP060
-Electronic gear and motor side gear SP061 to SP064
13255
-Position loop gain SP001 to SP003
-Conversion from the speed detection unit to position detection unit SP019, SP020
419 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
[1] The rotation speed command and actual rotation speed do not match.
[4] The vibration and noise (gear noise), etc., are large.
IB-1501229-F 420
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
[7] The speed does not rise above the command speed sometimes.
421 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
If dual signal error (4D) occurs, the sub-number and the axis name will appear on the NC Diagnosis screen as shown
below. Take measures for each sub-number referring to the following table.
Sub-
Name Alarm details Investigation details Remedies
No.
Check if the connector to disable
Either of the STO signals entered an Connect the connector to disable
STO on the front of the drive unit is
1 Power shutoff error input state while the STO function is STO correctly.
loosened.
disabled.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Check if the STO sequence on the
Either of the STO signals entered an
NC side (safety ladder side) issues
input state during servo ON Set correctly.
2 Illegal power shutoff error the STO command before the servo
command or during deceleration and
OFF command.
stop with the STO function enabled.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Input states of two STO signals were Check if the two STO output timings
Set correctly.
3 STO signal mismatch error mismatched while the STO function of the remote I/O unit are matched.
is enabled. No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
Safety communication: A receiving error was detected in the the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
15
Communication error 1 safety communication. (Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
A receiving error was detected in the
Safety communication: Initial the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
16 initial communication for the safety
communication error 1 (Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
communication.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
A power error was detected in the
17 Voltage diagnosis error The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
safety function.
A DRAM error was detected in the
19 DRAM diagnosis error The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
safety function.
An error was detected in the status of
21 Control process error software execution for the safety The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
function.
Turn the power OFF, and check the
An error was detected in the initial
Safety encoder: Initial encoder cable connection with a Replace the encoder cable.
23 communication with a safety
communication error 1 tester.
encoder.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the encoder.
A PCB error was detected in the
24 PCB error The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
safety function.
Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
A synchronization error was detected the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
25 Synchronization error
in the safety function. (Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
A Flash ROM error was detected in
26 Flash ROM diagnosis error The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
the safety function.
Turn the power OFF, and check the
An error was detected in the
Safety encoder: encoder cable connection with a Replace the encoder cable.
33 communication with a safety
Communication error 1 tester.
encoder.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the encoder.
Safety encoder: Diagnosis error
34 An error was detected in the encoder. The alarm is on the encoder side. Replace the encoder.
1
Safety encoder: Diagnosis error
35 An error was detected in the encoder. The alarm is on the encoder side. Replace the encoder.
2
Safety encoder: Diagnosis error
36 An error was detected in the encoder. The alarm is on the encoder side. Replace the encoder.
3
Safety encoder: Diagnosis error
37 An error was detected in the encoder. The alarm is on the encoder side. Replace the encoder.
4
Non-safety encoder: Position Check the safety parameters. Set correctly.
The position feedback from the non-
39 feedback fixation diagnosis
safety encoder remains unchanged. The alarm is on the encoder side. Replace the encoder.
error
The safety encoder detected a
40 Safety encoder: Thermal error The alarm is on the encoder side. Replace the encoder.
thermal error.
Check the safety parameters. Set correctly.
Safety communication: An error was detected in the Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
53 Transmission interval mismatch transmission interval setting sent the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
error from the NC. (Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
IB-1501229-F 422
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
Sub-
Name Alarm details Investigation details Remedies
No.
Check the safety parameters. Set correctly.
A receiving error was detected in the Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
Safety communication: Initial
54 initial communication for the safety the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
communication error 2
communication. (Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Check the safety parameters. Set correctly.
Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
Safety communication: A receiving error was detected in the
55 the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
Communication error 2 safety communication.
(Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Safety parameter setting range A setting error was detected in the Check the safety parameters. Set correctly.
56
error safety parameter. No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Safety parameter combination A combination error was detected in Check the safety parameters. Set correctly.
57
error the safety parameter. No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
A resister diagnosis error was
65 Register diagnosis error The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
detected in the safety function.
An error was detected in the
Calculation device diagnosis
66 calculation device diagnosis for the The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
error
safety function.
An error was detected in the
67 Sequence diagnosis error sequence diagnosis for the safety The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
function.
An error was detected in the stack
68 Stack diagnosis error The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
diagnosis for the safety function.
Take remedies according to the
Check if there is any abnormality in
An error was detected in the causes of the abnormality in the
69 Temperature diagnosis error the temperature environment.
temperature. ambient environment.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
The safety function is not operating
71 Watchdog error The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
correctly.
An error was detected in the clock
72 Clock diagnosis error The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
diagnosis for the safety function.
An error was detected in the status of
74 DO output compare error The alarm is on the drive unit side. Replace the drive unit.
DO output for the safety function.
Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
An error was detected in the inter-
the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
75 ISC communication error system communication for the safety
(Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
function.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
A receiving error was detected in the
Safety communication: Initial the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
78 initial communication for the safety
communication error 3 (Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
communication.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
An error was detected in the read- the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
88 Safety circuit: STO error
back diagnosis for STO. (Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Correctly connect according to the
An error was detected in the read- Check the wiring for motor brakes.
91 Safety circuit: SBC error starting method of the motor brakes.
back diagnosis for SBC.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
Check if there is any abnormality in Take remedies according to the
Safety communication: A receiving error was detected in the the unit's ambient environment. causes of the abnormality in the
126
Communication error 3 safety communication. (Ex. Noise, grounding) ambient environment.
No abnormality is found in particular. Replace the drive unit.
423 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
7 Troubleshooting
IB-1501229-F 424
8
Maintenance
425 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
WARNING
1. Before starting maintenance or inspections, turn the main circuit power and control power both OFF.
Wait at least fifteen minutes for the CHARGE lamp to turn OFF, and then using a tester, confirm that the input and output
voltage are zero. Failure to observe this could lead to electric shocks.
2. Inspections must be carried out by a qualified technician. Failure to observe this could lead to electric shocks. Contact
your nearest Mitsubishi branch or dealer for repairs and part replacement.
CAUTION
1. Never perform a megger test (measure the insulation resistance) of the drive unit.
Failure to observe this could lead to faults.
2. The user must never disassemble or modify this product.
CAUTION
Do not touch the motor for some time after turning OFF the power, as the motor remains at a high temperature.
This may lead to burns.
IB-1501229-F 426
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
[1] Remove fixing screws (hexagon socket screws at four locations) for the terminal box cover.
Terminal box cover Hexagon socket screws
at four locations
Spindle motor
[3] Remove the three lead wires (BU, BV, and BW) for the cooling fan from the one-touch terminal block.
[3-1] Applicable flat-blade screwdriver
Always use a flat-blade screwdriver whose blade edge size is 0.6×3.5mm for working.
(SZF1-0.6×3.5 manufactured by Phoenix Contact)
[3-2] Insert the screwdriver into the insertion point (small square hole) of the one-touch terminal block in a diagonal
direction. When the spring touches the blade edge, push the screwdriver down to the position that hits a
conductive plate to the direction of arrow (a), tilting it in the inside direction of the terminal block.
The screwdriver is held if it inserts appropriately.
[3-3] After confirming that the spring is open, slowly unplug the lead wires for the cooling fan to the direction of arrow
(b).
(a) Screwdriver
(b)
(Note 1) Do not let foreign objects enter the motor. In particular, if conductive objects such as screws or metal
wires, etc., or combustible materials such as oil enter, the motor could be damaged.
427 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
[4] Remove the fixing screws (hexagon socket screws at four locations) for the cooling fan unit.
A
Hexagon socket screws
at four locations
(Note 1) Some spindle motors have the fixing screws (hexagon socket screws) for the cooling fan unit at two
locations.
[5] Slowly unplug the lead wire of the cooling fan from the section where the lead wire for the cooling fan is led out. At
this time, slowly unplug the protection tube which protects the lead wire for the cooling fan together. Slowly unplug
the protection tube by pushing it out from inside the terminal box or pulling it from outside the terminal box not to
overload the cooling fan side.
B
Protection tube
(Note 1) Take special care not to damage the lead wire for the cooling fan.
IB-1501229-F 428
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
[6] Slowly remove the cooling fan unit in the direction of arrow (c).
Spindle motor
(c)
Cooling fan unit
(Note 1) Do not strike the side face of the cooling fan unit. Failure to observe this may result in damages of the fan
unit.
Side face of
the cooling fan unit
Spindle motor
(Note 2) Perform it so as not to touch the edge part of the cooling fan unit. Failure to observe this may result in
injury.
(Note 3) Do not grip the cooling fan lead wire (including the protection tube) when carrying the cooling fan unit.
Carrying with gripping them may result in damages of the fan unit.
429 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
Bellmouth
Hexagon socket screws
at four locations
(Note 1) Some spindle motors have the bellmouth fixing screws (hexagon socket screws) at two locations.
(Note 1) Perform it so as not to touch the edge part of the cooling fan unit or the end part of the bellmouth. Failure
to observe this may result in injury.
(Note 2) Do not let bellmouth fixing screws enter the cooling fan unit. Failure to observe this could lead to
breakage or faults of the cooling fan.
(3) Cleaning
[1] Check the situation of the cooling fan blade part and inside the case of the cooling fan unit by visual inspection.
IB-1501229-F 430
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
[2] Clean up the inside of the cooling fan unit and the cooling air vent.
Wipe dirt off the inside of the cooling fan unit and the cooling air vent using wastes, etc.
Spindle motor
Cooling fan unit
(Note 1) Never disassemble or modify the cooling fan. Failure to observe this could lead to breakage or faults of
the cooling fan.
(Note 2) Do not drop the cooling fan or immerse it in water. Failure to observe this could lead to breakage or faults
of the cooling fan.
(Note 3) Do not use air blow as this may cause foreign matters to enter the inner part of the cooling fan motor.
(Note 4) Do not wash with liquid detergent as the cooling fan motor is an electrical appliance.
(Note 5) Take extra care not to damage the cooling fan during cleaning.
L= approx. 500 mm
Cleaning jig A
(Body:a wire stick of approx. 䕮2mm)
Brush part
approx. 䕮10mm
Cleaning jig B (a brush is attached
at the top of the cleaning jig A)
431 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
[3-2] Use the cleaning jigs to clean the air ducts of the spindle motor frame.
Insert the cleaning jigs A and B into the motor frame's air ducts from the counter-load side of the spindle motor,
scrape out the dirt, and wipe it off with wastes, etc.
Spindle motor C
View C-C
(4) Assembling
[1] After all the cleaning processes have been completed, attach the cooling fan unit to the motor in the order opposite
to that of the detachment process.
[2] Precautions in installing cooling fan unit
(a) The section where the cooling fan lead wires are led out must be in the state without a space by inserting a
protection tube for the cooling fan. A space could lead to faults of the motor by allowing foreign matters enter
there.
IB-1501229-F 432
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
(b) Draw the lead wires including the protection tube of the cooling fan unit into the terminal box not to project at
the back side of the motor. Failure to observe this could lead to breakage of the lead wires.
Spindle motor
Cooling fan unit
(c) When installing the three lead wires (BU, BV, and BW) of the cooling fan to the one-touch terminal block, do
not mistake the terminal connections. Improper connection could lead to breakage or malfunction.
(d) Make sure not to pinch the cooling fan lead wire when installing the terminal box cover. Failure to observe this
could lead to electric shocks.
[3] After attaching the unit, perform a test run to check the air blow direction of the fan, etc.
Exhaust
Spindle motor
Cooling fan unit
433 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
[1] Disconnect the cooling fan's terminals from the terminal block (See the diagram below).
Spindle motor
[2] Detach the cooling fan unit from the spindle motor.
Remove the four hexagon socket screws used to secure the cooling fan unit to the spindle motor.
Finger guard
Spindle motor A
When slowly removing the cooling fan unit from the spindle motor, also unplug the fan drive cable slowly with the
rubber packing left in the terminal box.
(Note 1) Pull out the solderless terminals one by one as the hole on the terminal box is small.
(Note 2) Take extra care not to damage the cable.
IB-1501229-F 434
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
(2) Cleaning
(a) Clean up the backside of the cooling fan unit and the air duct in the counter-load side bracket of the spindle motor.
Wipe dirt off the backside of the cooling fan unit and the air duct of the counter-load side bracket using wastes, etc.
(Note 1) Do not use air blow as this may cause foreign matters to enter the inner part of the cooling fan motor.
(Note 2) Do not wash with liquid detergent as the cooling fan motor is an electrical appliance.
Spindle motor B
C Cooling fan unit Cooling fan unit
Air duct
(b) Clean up the inner part of the fan case and the air duct of the spindle motor body
[1] Prepare the cleaning jigs (two types) as illustrated below.
The main body of the jigs A and B is a wire stick (approx. Φ2mm) with the length of approx. 500mm. A brush
is attached at the top of the cleaning jig B. For the brush on the jig B, do not choose a hard brush such as the
one made of wires.
L= approx. 500
Brush part
435 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
[2] Detach the finger guard from the cooling fan unit.
Remove the four screws used for securing the finger guard.
Finger guard
Spindle motor
D
Cooling fan unit
View D-D
[3] Wipe dirt off the finger guard using wastes, etc.
[4] Use the cleaning jigs to clean the inner part of the cooling fan case.
Use the cleaning jigs A and B to scrape out dirt between the fan case and blades in the cooling fan unit, and
wipe it off with wastes, etc.
(Note 1) Do not use air blow as this may cause foreign matters to enter the inner part of the cooling fan
motor.
(Note 2) Do not wash with liquid detergent as the cooling fan motor is an electrical appliance.
(Note 3) Take extra care not to damage the cooling fan during cleaning.
IB-1501229-F 436
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
[5] Use the cleaning jigs to clean the air ducts of the spindle motor body.
Insert the cleaning jigs A and B into the motor's air ducts from the counter-load side bracket, scrape out the
dirt, and wipe it off with wastes, etc.
Spindle motor E
Cooling fan unit
View E-E
(3) Assembling
After all the cleaning processes have been completed, attach the cooling fan unit to the motor in the order opposite to
that of the detachment process. After attaching the unit, perform a test run to check the air blow direction of the fan, etc.
Be careful not to pinch the cable between the cooling fan unit and the terminal box.
Exhaust
437 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
IB-1501229-F 438
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
CAUTION
1. Correctly transport the product according to its weight. Failure to do so could result in injury.
2. Do not stack the product above the indicated limit.
3. Installation directly on or near combustible materials could result in fires.
4. Install the unit as indicated at a place which can withstand the weight.
5. Do not get on or place heavy objects on the unit. Failure to observe this could result in injury.
6. Always use the unit within the designated environment condition range.
7. Do not allow conductive foreign matter such as screws or metal chips, or combustible foreign matter such as oil enter the
servo drive or servo motor.
8. Do not block the intake or exhaust ports of the servo drive of servo motor. Failure to observe this could result in faults.
9. The servo drive and servo motor are precision devices. Do not drop them or apply strong impacts.
10.Do not install or operate a servo drive or servo motor which is damaged or missing parts.
11.When the unit has been stored for a long time, contact the Service Center or Service Station.
12.Connect the encoder(CN2/CN3) immediately after the installation of the servo drive unit. In addition, when a battery box
is used, immediately connect to the BTA/BTB connector. (prevention of absolute position data lost)
Procedures
[1] Turn the breaker for the input power OFF. Make sure the CHARGE lamp of the power supply unit is turned
OFF.
[2] Disconnect all the connectors and the wires connected to the drive unit.
[3] Remove the two (four) screws fixing the drive unit onto the control panel. Remove the drive unit from the
control panel.
[4] Make a same setting for the rotary switch and the dip switch of the new drive unit as those of the uninstalled
drive unit.
[5] Install a new drive unit by following the removal procedure in reverse.
(3) Restoration
Data backup and restoration is not required before replacing drive units because drive units’ data such as
parameters are stored in the controller. However, carry out a backup of the whole system before replacement as a
precautionary measure.
The power for keeping the encoder’s position data of an absolute position system is supplied from the battery
connected to the drive unit. Keep the power ON once for 30 minutes or more if possible, and make sure to complete
the replacement within 60 minutes after charging the encoder’s capacitor.
439 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
POINT
When the drive unit of E/EH Series which uses two cooling fans is in an emergency stop or alarm,
one of fans (upper one in the case of vertical layout, or either one in the case of horizontal layout) is stopped and power-
saving operation is performed. If the suspended fan is restarted by canceling the emergency stop, it is not a problem with
the fan.
IB-1501229-F 440
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
441 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
CAUTION
1. When the battery voltage is low (warning 9F), do not shut OFF the power of the drive unit until replacement of the battery
to protect the data.
2. Replace the MDSBTBOX-LR2060 battery with new batteries (LR20) that is within the recommended service period.
CAUTION
1. Replace the batteries with new ones immediately after the battery voltage drop alarm (9F) has been output.
2. Replace the batteries while applying the drive unit’s control power.
BTA BTB
1 2 1 2
BTI BTO
Battery unit
2 1 2 1
IB-1501229-F 442
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
CAUTION
1. Use new batteries that are within the recommended service period. (Check the recommended service period written on
the batteries before using them.)
2. Replace the batteries with new ones immediately after the battery voltage drop alarm (9F) has been output.
3. Replace the batteries while applying the servo drive unit’s control power.
4. Wrong connection may cause liquid leakage, heat generation and/or explosion.
5. Do not mix new batteries with used ones or mix different type batteries.
443 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
8 Maintenance
IB-1501229-F 444
9
Power Backup System
445 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
CAUTION
The power backup unit (MDS-D/DH-PFU) and regenerative resistor unit (R-UNIT6,7) options are required when using the
deceleration and stop function at power failure.
9.1.1 Specifications of Stop Method for Deceleration and Stop Function at Power Failure
System
The power backup system is a system to protect the machine and drive units at a power failure. When it is used, stop
methods during some operations are different from those of when it is not used. See below for the stop methods of
<servo system> and <spindle system> when the power backup system is not used ((1) in the tables) and when it is used
((2) in the tables) depending on what is occurring.
< Servo system >
IB-1501229-F 446
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
CN41
CN41
R1 R1
AC TE5
Circuit reactor Contactor R2 R2
protector
R L1
S L2 TE1
T L3
L+ TE2 TE2
L+ L+ L+ TE2
TE2
MC MC1 L- L-
CN23 L- L-
Ground
MC2
TE3 TE3
L11 TE3 L11 L11 OUT- L11 TE3
L1
L2 TE1
L3
Circuit
protector Ground Ground Ground Ground
(Note 1) When multiple power supply units are used, each power supply unit must be connected with one power
backup unit. It is not possible to connect multiple power supply units to one power backup unit.
(Note 2) Select the power supply that can be retained until the completion of deceleration stop operation for the
24V power supply of dynamic brake unit and MP scale.
(Note 3) In the system with multiple power supply units, each power supply unit must be connected with one
power backup unit.
(Note 4) Connect the control power supply (L11,L21) of the unit where the deceleration and stop function is not
used to a commercial AC power supply.
CAUTION
Connect the PFU's TE3 (OUT-L11, OUT-L21) to L11 and L21 of each unit. Do not connect them to a commercial AC power
supply. The unit will be damaged if connecting the PFU's TE3 to a commercial AC power supply. When retrofitting the PFU,
disconnect commercial AC power from L11, L21.
447 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
10A AL1
CN43 10B
AL2
Available wire size:0.2 mm 2
5m or less
E
CAUTION
1. Make sure to install the regenerative resistor for external option power backup unit to enable the deceleration and stop
function at power failure.
2. Only the designated combination can be used for the external option regenerative resistor and drive unit. There is a risk
of fire, so always use the designated combination.
CAUTION
Refer to "9.3.1 How to Set Rotary Switch and Dip Switches" for detail specifications on the rotary switch (SW1) and dip
switches (SW2, SW3) of MDS-D/DH-PFU.
IB-1501229-F 448
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
ptyp
rtyp
amp
ptyp
rtyp
amp
449 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
CAUTION
1. The power backup unit (MDS-D/DH-PFU) and capacitor unit (MDS-D/DH-CU) options are required when using the
retraction function at power failure. Whether the regenerative resistor unit (R-UNIT6,7) is required or not is decided
depending on the spindle stop operation (Deceleration and stop or Coast to a stop) at power failure.
2. Refer to the specifications manual of NC system for details on the NC settings relevant to the hob retraction function.
10B AL2
CN41
CN41
R1 R1
AC TE5
Circuit reactor Contactor R2 R2
protector
R L1
S L2 TE1
T L3 C+ C+ TE1
L+ TE2 TE2
L+ L+ L+ TE4
TE2 TE2 C- C-
MC MC1 L- L-
Ground CN23 L- L- The
MC2 regenerative
resistor unit is
TE3 TE3 required to
L11 TE3 L11 L11 OUT- L11 TE3
decelerate and
L21 L21 L21 OUT- L21 stop the
spindle at
L1 power failure.
L2 TE1
L3
Circuit
protector Ground Ground Ground Ground
(Note 1) When using the retraction function at power failure, uninterruptible power supply (UPS) is required for NC
power.
(Note 2) Connect the capacitor unit's TE1(C+,C-) to PFU's TE4(C+,C-).
(Do not connect them to PFU's TE2(L+,L-) or TE5(R1,R2).)
(Note 3) Do not reverse the polarity of C+ and C- when connecting the capacitor unit.
(Note 4) Securely perform the switch setting and control signal connection.
(Note 5) DO2 (tool escape request) of CN43 is used for the retraction function at power failure. Input the DO2
signal to DI of the NC so that DO2 can turn ON the retraction request signal (YCDE) through the PLC
sequence.
(Note 6) In the system with multiple power supply units, each power supply unit must be connected with one
power backup unit.
(Note 7) Connect the control power supply (L11,L21) of the unit where the retraction function at power failure is
not used to a commercial AC power supply.
CAUTION
Connect the PFU's TE3 (OUT-L11, OUT-L21) to L11 and L21 of each unit.
Do not connect them to a commercial AC power supply. The unit will be damaged if connecting the PFU's TE3 to a
commercial AC power supply.
IB-1501229-F 450
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
Fixing band
10m or less
CAUTION
1. Only the designated combination can be used for the power backup unit and the capacitor unit.
There is a risk of fire, so always use the designated combination.
2. Connect the power backup unit's TE4(C+,C-) to the capacitor unit's TE1(C+,C-), and do not reverse the polarity.
3. When using multiple capacitor units, connect with TE2 (C+,C-) of capacitor units.
451 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
1B 2.2kΩ
2B
DO_COM
2.2kΩ
24V
2.2kΩ
5B DO2
NC
Control
unit
COM
0V
1A
DO_COM2
Source type
[ Regenerative resistor unit ]
24G
10B A L1
10A A L2
When using external 24V power (connection to sink type input DI)
1B 2.2kΩ
2B
DO_COM
2.2kΩ
0V
2.2kΩ
5B DO2
NC
Control
unit
COM
24V
1A
DO_COM2
[ Regenerative resistor unit ] Sink type
24G
10B A L1
10A A L2
IB-1501229-F 452
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
< Spindle stop operation after the retraction is completed : Coast to a stop >
• MDS-D-PFU / MDS-DH-PFU
Rotary switch (SW1) setting : 0 Regenerative resistor unit is not connected
CAUTION
Refer to "9.3.1 How to Set Rotary Switch and Dip Switches" for detail specifications on the rotary switch (SW1) and dip
switches (SW2, SW3) of MDS-D/DH-PFU.
453 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
ptyp
rtyp
amp
ptyp
rtyp
amp
IB-1501229-F 454
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
4
Power failure detection time for OFF Standard setting (60ms)
5
5 AC input voltage
(including open-phase detection
signal) ON High-speed setting (20ms)
2 R-UNIT-7
- - 1.4 2100
33∼13
to 13 Setting prohibited (*2)
14 Setting prohibited
15 Setting prohibited
*2: If you select this, the function selection error (Alarm 18) will occur in the power backup unit.
In initializing
Initializing completed
In ready ON
(In Charging)
Ready ON state
(Charge completed)
455 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
CAUTION
An alarm/warning No. of the power backup system is not displayed on the NC screen. When an alarm/warning of the power
backup system occurs, the following power supply alarm/warning is displayed on the NC screen
Check the details of the alarm/warning according to the LED display of the power backup unit.
“Power supply option unit error: Alarm 74”
“Power supply option unit error: Warning EF”
IB-1501229-F 456
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
Reset
No. Name Details Detection period
method
8 Watchdog The system does not operate correctly. After initialized AR
10 Memory error 1 An internal memory error was detected during the power ON self-check.
At initializing AR
11 Memory error 2 An error was detected in the internal clock signal.
12 Unit ID error An error was detected in the internal hardware ID. At initializing AR
An error was detected in the A/D converter, which is used for detecting
13 A/D converter error After initialized AR
current and voltage.
18 Function selection error An error was detected in the settings of DIP or rotary switches. At initializing AR
The external emergency stop cancel state was detected although the
19 External emergency stop setting error After initialized AR
external emergency stop input is set as disabled.
1A Resistor unit connection error Resistor unit disconnection was detected. After initialized AR
Non-connection of capacitor was detected although the capacitor unit
1B Capacitor connection error First ready-ON AR
connection is set as enabled.
Communication error was detected in the connection to the power supply
1C Power supply unit Connect error After initialized PR
unit.
50 S/W processing error Software processing has not finished within the specified time. After initialized PR
51 Main circuit error An error was detected in a thyristor or charging circuit. After initialized PR
An error was detected in the output changeover relay or power output of the
52 Control power output circuit error After initialized PR
control power supply.
An error was detected in the resistor regeneration transistor or regeneration
53 Resistor unit circuit error After initialized PR
output.
An error was detected in the rush circuit relay or rush resistor of the control
54 Inrush circuit error After initialized PR
power supply.
Over current in control power output An excessive current was detected in the control power supply backup output
55 After initialized PR
circuit circuit.
56 Overheat in control power output circuit An overheat was detected in the control power supply backup output circuit. After initialized PR
An abnormal resistor unit value was detected during the power ON self-
58 Resistor unit error After initialized PR
check.
90 Over voltage The voltage between L+/L- of the main circuit has exceeded the tolerance. After initialized NR (*)
(Note 1)"b", "C" and "d" displayed on the power backup unit's LED as a solid light (not flickering) do not indicate an alarm.
(Note 2)Resetting methods
PR: Reset by turning the NC power ON again. This alarm can also be reset with the AR resetting conditions.
AR: Reset by turning the power backup unit power ON again.
NR: Reset with NC reset (Alarms with * must satisfy the resetting conditions)
Reset
No. Name Details Detection period
method
- AC power supply voltage decrease was detected.
D0 Instantaneous power interruption - Loss of phase was detected. After initialized *
- Bus voltage decrease was detected.
D1 Over regeneration Over-regeneration detection level exceeded 100%. After initialized *
D5 Resistor unit overheat Thermal error was detected in resistor unit. After initialized *
(Note1) Resetting method
*: Automatically reset once the cause of the warning is removed.
457 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
IB-1501229-F 458
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
459 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
Overvoltage :
Alarm No. The voltage between L+/L- of the main circuit has exceeded the tolerance. The voltage between L+/L- is relatively high
90 immediately after the occurrence of this alarm. Therefore, wait for 5 minutes or longer until the voltage drops, and then cancel this
alarm by reset.
Investigation details Investigation results Remedies
This error occurs every time the motor decelerates
Check the investigation item No. 2.
1 Check the reproducibility. at power failure or at power supply alarm.
This error occurs occasionally. Check the investigation item No. 3.
Decrease the machine’s load inertia and the
Check the machine's load inertia and the maximum Increased than before.
2 maximum motor rotation speed.
motor rotation speed.
No change. Check the investigation item No. 4.
Voltage is exceeding the specified maximum Change the power supply voltage to be within the
3 Check the power supply voltage. value. specified range.
Voltage is below the specified limit. Check the investigation item No. 4.
Capacity is not sufficient. Use a resistor unit with a greater capacity.
4 Check the capacity of the resistor unit.
Capacity is sufficient. Check the investigation item No. 5.
Check if there is any abnormality in the unit's
5 ambient environment. (Ex. Ambient temperature, Take remedies according to the causes of the abnormality in the ambient environment.
noise, grounding)
IB-1501229-F 460
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
Over regeneration :
Warning No. Over-regeneration detection level became over 100%.The regenerative resistor is overloaded.The warning is not released even
D1 if the power turns ON again.
The warning is released if over-regeneration level drops to less than 80% in power ON state (usually takes 20 minutes).
Investigation details Investigation results Remedies
This error occurs every time the motor decelerates
Check the investigation item No. 2.
1 Check the reproducibility. at power failure or at power supply alarm.
This error occurs occasionally. Check the investigation item No. 3.
Decrease the machine’s load inertia and the
Check the machine's load inertia and the maximum Increased than before.
2 maximum motor rotation speed.
motor rotation speed.
No change. Check the investigation item No. 4.
Reduce the frequency at which power failure or
Check the frequency at which power failure or Occurs more than once per hour.
3 power supply alarm occurs.
power supply alarm occurs.
The frequency is low. Check the investigation item No. 4.
Capacity is not sufficient. Use a resistor unit with a greater capacity.
4 Check the capacity of the resistor unit.
Capacity is sufficient. Replace the power backup unit.
461 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
9 Power Backup System
LED
Symptom Cause of occurrence Investigation method Remedy
display
PFU's internal fuse is Check whether the power voltage is If voltage is properly input, replace
None PFU unit fails to start.
open. properly input to L1, L2 and L3. the power backup unit.
Check if the DO3 signal of CN43 is
Unable to cancel emergency stop. correctly connected to CN23A of the Connect correctly.
External emergency stop is occurring Disconnection of the DO3 power supply unit.
b
on the power supply unit. (The LED on signal of CN43. Check if the 24V power supply of
power supply unit shows "q".) DO3 signal is correctly connected to Connect correctly.
DO_COM terminal.
Disconnection of the
Unable to cancel emergency stop. resistor unit or an illegal Check the investigation items of the alarm No. 1A.
External emergency stop is occurring resistance value.
1A
on the power supply unit. (The LED on PFU's internal resistor Unplug L+/L-, C+/C- and R1/R2
If short-circuited, replace the power
power supply unit shows "q".) regeneration transistor is from the PFU unit, and measure the
backup unit.
broken. resistance between L+/L- terminals.
Unable to cancel emergency stop. The PFU's internal resistor Unplug L+/L-, C+/C- and R1/R2
If short-circuited, replace the power
51 alarm 6C (Power supply: Main circuit regeneration transistor is from the PFU unit, and measure the
backup unit.
error) is occurring. broken. resistance between L+/L- terminals.
An error in the control
52 Power supply or drive unit fails to start. Check the investigation items of the alarm No. 52.
power output circuit.
Unable to cancel emergency stop.
External emergency stop is occurring Over-regeneration
d1 Check the investigation items of the warning No. D1.
on the power supply unit. (The LED on protection is working.
power supply unit shows "q".)
Unable to cancel emergency stop.
An overheat was detected
External emergency stop is occurring
d5 by the thermal sensor of Check the investigation items of the warning No. D5.
on the power supply unit. (The LED on
the resistor unit.
power supply unit shows "q".)
IB-1501229-F 462
10
Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
463 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
Cable
Cable
Clamp nut
Bushing
Back shell
Angle
back shell
IB-1501229-F 464
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
(Note) Make sure that the core wire does not come out of the contact.
When soldering, make sure that the solder does not stick to the circumference of the solder cup.
When using a drain wire, attach a heat shrink tube to the drain cable after soldering.
* When making CMV1-xP10S-xx, the cable for No. 10 terminal is 1mm longer than other cables. (To avoid
the core tension when inserting a contact to the housing in a later process.)
* The difference in the total A length of the cables for other than No. 10 terminal must be 1mm or less.
Solder
Difference in total length: 1 mm or less
(for other than No. 10 terminal)
C Detail C
Cable
Core wire
Contact
Drain wire
Contact Housing
(5) Inserting the contact Cable
Insert the contact into the specified terminal number point in
the housing.
(Insert grounding wire or drain wire into terminal No. 10).
* When the contact catches the housing, you will hear
a snap. Insert
Terminal No.10 only
* Pulling the wire for confirming the correct position. (Grounding wire or drain wire)
(Note) Before inserting the contact, check that the clamp nut, cable clamp, bushing and back shell is inserted.
Take care not to insert the contact upside down as shown below.
Terminal number
* Insert the contact so that the terminal number face the same
Lance
direction.
* As Lance falls down easily after pulling up, set up to original Lance
position before re-insert.
Contact CMV1-xP2S-xx
465 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
Insert
Back shell coupling
Back shell Insert
Back shell coupling
Temporarily
tighten Back shell coupling
Temporarily tighten
Tightening guide
Tightening Set
19
guide
Back shell * Referential dimensions for
wrench
back shell tightening guide
15 (Back shell width)
20
Thickness:
10
Back shell
wrench Tighten * Recommendation:
Tightening guide
● Recommended jigs and tools : (357J-53234T)
Back shell wrench (357J-51333T) (Note 2)
Bit (357J-51344T)
Torque wrench (CL6N x 8D,Tonichi Mfg.)
* Recommended tightening guide: (357J-53234T) (Note 2)
IB-1501229-F 466
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
Tightening guide
Set
Tighten 19
Torque wrench
* Referential dimensions for back
shell tightening guide
15
(Back shell width)
Bushing
Cable clamp Bushing
Cable clamp
Cable Cable
Back shell
Back shell
Insert
Insert
(Note) After the Bushing insert, confirm that cable position should be inside of Bushing.
467 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
* Recommendation
Adhesive (2 threads around
Temporary tightening the circumference)
Tightening
guide Clamp nut Tightening guide
Back shell
19 Set
* Referential dimensions for back
shell tightening guide
15 (Back shell width)
20
Clamp nut ● Recommended jigs and tools :
wrench Clamp nut wrench(357J-51334T)(Note 2)
Thickness:
10 Bit (357J-51345T)
Torque wrench (CL6N x 8D, Tonichi Mfg.)
* Recommendation :
Torque * Recommended tightening jig : (357J-53234T)
Tightening guide
wrench (Note 2)
(357J-53234T)
Tighten
Tightening guide
Torque wrench
Angle back shell
Clamp nut
Set
IB-1501229-F 468
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
<When connecting>
Ⴎmark Ⴎmark Ⴎmark
[1] Set the ڹmark of each other’s connectors. Ⴎmark
Push it straight
(1) (1)
* To remove, rotate the coupling and Rotate the coupling Rotate the coupling
pull out to straight.
(2) (2)
Pull out to Pull out to
Coupling straight Coupling straight
Conduit Saddle
Conduit
Cable Cable Saddle
Protective cover
(rubber etc.) Protective cover
(rubber etc.)
Recommended conduit
Type: VF Type: SR Type: FBN Type: EM Type: VFS Type: SRK etc. (Note)
Recommended connector
Type:RCM (Note)
469 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
Receptacle contact
(4) Refer to Application Specification (114-5335) and crimp the contacts. After crimping,
check the state in accordance with the Specification.
IB-1501229-F 470
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
(5) Verifying the direction, insert the crimped contact into the receptacle housing.
After the insertion, pull each wire lightly to make sure that the contacts are fully
inserted. (Lock feeling and sound can be confirmed when the contact is fully/
correctly inserted.)
1mm
Positioning the cable jacket end as shown in the right figure. Refer to the Application
Specification (114-5338) and crimp the ground clip.
(7) Store the receptacle housing and ground clip in the receptacle case.
Pull the cable side and draw the receptacle housing side as shown in the right figure,
without pushing in it.
Pull
Work will become easy when the crimping part of the ground clip is pushed and the
cable is bent as shown in the right figure. Push
When the ground clip interferes with receptacle case at the position in the right figure
and cause difficulty in continuing to draw in, push the ground clip to distort and drawing
become easy.
Distortion
(Note) To prevent a fracture, do not use the ground clip which is bend and unbend 3
times or more. Push
Push
Turn the form of the ground clip back to normal and position it for the
receptacle case as shown in the right figure. Contact Projection
Adjust the projection of receptacle housing to the slit of the receptacle case
and push in until it is fixed to the case. Slit A ground clip is stuck
in a receptacle case.
(Note) See that the contact of receptacle housing goes inside a ground
clip.
471 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
10 Appx. 1: Cable and Connector Assembly
(8) Shift the wire rubber packing and wire clamp to the position in the right figure,
and tighten the wire fixed set screw to fix the cable to receptacle case.
No space
Tighten it not to create the space between the receptacle case and wire fixed
set screw.
No space
(Note) Confirm that the cable is fixed.
POST BASE for inspection
(9) To ensure that there is no leaning on the receptacle housing in the receptacle
case assembly, drop the POST BASE for inspection naturally as shown in the
right figure.
Receptacle case assembly
(10) Insert the assembled connector until it stick fast to the POST BASE and then,
tighten the four bind screws to fix. The tightening torque of the bind screw is
5.0 to 10.0 N•cm.
IB-1501229-F 472
11
Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
473 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
CN9 connector
Pin Name Pin Name
LG LG
M01 M02
MDS-E/EH
Item Explanation
No. of channels 2ch
Output cycle 0.8ms (min. value)
Output precision 12bit
Output voltage range 0V to 2.5V (zero) to +5V
Output magnification setting -32768 to 32767 (1/100-fold)
Output pin (CN9 connector) MO1 = Pin 9, MO2 = Pin 19, LG = Pin 1,11
The D/A output for the 2-axis or 3-axis unit is also 2ch. When using the 2-axis or 3-axis unit,
Others always set -1 for the output data (SV061, SV062 / SP125,SP126) of the axis that is not to
be measured.
When the output data is 0, the offset voltage is 2.5V. If there is an offset voltage, adjust the zero level position in the
measuring instrument side.
+5 [V]
Speed FB
+2.5 [V]
0 [V]
+5 [V]
Current FB
+2.5 [V]
0 [V]
Example of D/A output waveform
IB-1501229-F 474
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
---Setting range---
-32768 to 32767
---Setting range---
-32768 to 32767
475 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
Servo control input (NC to Servo) Servo control output (Servo to NC)
No. Details No. Details
16384 Servo control input 1-0 READY ON command 16480 Servo control output 1-0 In READY ON
16385 Servo control input 1-1 Servo ON command 16481 Servo control output 1-1 In servo ON
16391 Servo control input 1-7 Alarm reset command 16487 Servo control output 1-7 In alarm
Current limit selection
16392 Servo control input 1-8 16488 Servo control output 1-8 In current limit selection
command
IB-1501229-F 476
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
---Setting range---
-32768 to 32767
---Setting range---
-32768 to 32767
No. Output data Output unit for standard setting Output cycle
-1 D/A output stop -
0 Commanded motor rotation speed 1000(r/min)/V 0.8ms
1 Motor rotation speed 1000(r/min)/V 0.8ms
2 Torque current command Short time rated ratio 100%/V 0.8ms
3 Torque current feedback Short time rated ratio 100%/V 0.8ms
477 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
D/A output
Details Description
No.
Motor end PLG installation gap is diagnosed.
Motor end PLG installation When the gap is good, 2.5V is output.
120
Gap diagnosis When the gap is excessive, 2.5V+1V is output.
When the gap is too small, 2.5V-1V is output.
Motor end PLG installation error (including the gap) is diagnosed.
Motor end PLG installation
121 When the installation is good, 2.5V is output.
All errors diagnosis
When the installation is incorrect, 2.5V+1V is output.
Spindle end PLG installation Spindle end PLG installation gap is diagnosed.
122
Gap diagnosis Diagnostic procedure is the same as that of motor end PLG.
Spindle end PLG installation Spindle end PLG installation error (including the gap) is diagnosed.
123
All errors diagnosis Diagnostic procedure is the same as that of motor end PLG.
IB-1501229-F 478
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
Spindle control input (NC to Spindle) Spindle control output (Spindle to NC)
No. Details No. Details
16384 Spindle control input 1-0 READY ON command 16480 Spindle control output 1-0 In ready ON
16385 Spindle control input 1-1 Servo ON command 16481 Spindle control output 1-1 In servo ON
16391 Spindle control input 1-7 Alarm reset command 16487 Spindle control output 1-7 In alarm
Torque limit 1 selection
16392 Spindle control input 1-8 16488 Spindle control output 1-8 In torque limit 1 selection
command
Torque limit 2 selection
16393 Spindle control input 1-9 16489 Spindle control output 1-9 In torque limit 2 selection
command
Torque limit 3 selection
16394 Spindle control input 1-A 16490 Spindle control output 1-A In torque limit 3 selection
command
479 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
---Setting range---
-32768 to 32767 (1/100-fold)
---Setting range---
-32768 to 32767 (1/100-fold)
IB-1501229-F 480
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
---Setting range---
-32768 to 32767 (1/100-fold)
---Setting range---
-32768 to 32767 (1/100-fold)
《Speed FB》
+5 [V] +5 [V]
SP125=0 - 0.5 SP125=0
3000r/min (forward run) SP127=50 3000r/min (reverse run) SP127=100
+4.0
Magnification +2. 5
2000r/min/V change 1000r/min/V
+1. 5
481 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
11 Appx. 2: D/A Output Specifications for Drive Unit
IB-1501229-F 482
12
Appx. 3: Protection Function
483 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function
When an operator requests to open the safety door, enable the safety function and release the lock on the safety door.
Safety is ensured by enabling the safety function while the safety door is open. When canceling the safety door open
request, the safety door enters the locked state and safety function will be released.
WARNING
The sequence of enabling or disabling the safety function by opening or closing the door is required to take necessary
actions at the machine tool builders.
IB-1501229-F 484
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function
(a) Connection
MDS-E/EH-V1/V2/V3/SP/SP2 MDS-E/EH-CV
Emergency
stop
Mitsubishi NC Emergency
Alarm stop
OPTH1 CN1A
Optical Alarm
EMG communication CN4 CN4 CN23
G380 cable SH21 cable
3 MC2
Contactor shutoff
2 (NC)
command
1 MC1
CN24
External emergency stop input
1A EMG2
(24VDC)
4A EMG1
External emergency
stop switch
CAUTION
1. The emergency stop signal input to the CNC side cannot be used as a substitute for the external emergency stop
function (CN9B).
2. To provide double-protection when an emergency stop occurs, the emergency stop input of NC and the external
emergency stop input of drive unit are always wired from same emergency stop switch.
3. The external emergency stop function is a function which helps the NC emergency stop.
485 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function
NC ON
Emergency stop input (EMG) Cancel
Motor speed 0
IB-1501229-F 486
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function
NC ON
Emergency stop input (EMG) Cancel
Motor speed 0
Gate off delay time
ON SV055/SP055
Contactor control output (MC)
OFF
NC ON
Emergency stop input (EMG) Cancel
Motor speed 0
The contactor is shut off after RDY
signal turns OFF, or after set time
of SV055 or SP055.
Contactor control output (MC) ON
OFF
487 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function
(1) Connection
The following three wirings are required for the SLS function.
[1] The state signal for the safety door of the machine is wired to both the NC unit side (DI) and drive unit side
(CN9 connector MPI1). The double-protection for the wiring must be provided by wiring the signal to each of
the NC side and drive unit side as the following figure.
[2] Add the wiring to control the contactor in the NC unit side in order to shut the power when an error occurs.
[3] In addition to the emergency stop wiring for the NC unit, add the external emergency stop wiring for the CN24
connector of the power supply unit.
CN23
[2]
L+
L-
Breaker
or
fuse
(Note)
Prepared by
To 2th and 3th axis user
servo
Contactor
(Note)
Prepared by
user
AC reactor
3-phase AC
power supply
CAUTION
The door state signal input port is also used for other signal input depending on the parameter setting. When the input is
duplicated, consider to wire the door state signal to other drive units connecting to the same NC communication line.
IB-1501229-F 488
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function
CAUTION
1. Make sure to input one of the door status signal for each control system to CN9B connector of servo or spindle drive unit.
In the control system, it is conveyed to the axis which is not directly connected via the NC.
2. Using the SLS (Safely Limited Speed) function, it is required to set parameter in addition to the wiring mentioned above.
To prevent a certain axis from being involved in the SLS (Safely Limited Speed) function, set SV113/bitF or SP229/bitF
to 0.
The digital signal input selection is set to "1" for the drive unit connected with the door state signal. The digital signal
input selection is set to "0" for the other drive unit not connected with the signal.
489 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function
Sets the safely limited speed of the machine and motor for which the SLS (Safely Limited Speed) function is
executed.
0: mm/min 1: 100mm/min
---Setting range---
---Setting range---
(Note) The value of the safely limited speed and safely limited motor speed must satisfy the above relation.
If this relation is not satisfied, the parameter error (37or E4) will occur.(Error parameter No. is 239.)
Checking this relation is executed when the drive unit is turned ON and parameter is changed and speed
observation mode (states when a speed observation command is turned ON) is entered.
Note that "1 (r/min)" is applied when the calculation result is "0 (r/min)"
IB-1501229-F 490
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function
The digital signal input selection is set to "1" for the drive unit connected with the door state signal.
The digital signal input selection is set to "0" for the other drive unit not connected with the signal.
bit D : rps Safely limited speed setting unit
0: Normal 1: 100°/min
Change the setting units of the specified speed signal output speed (SP030) and safely limited
speed (SP238).
Sets the safely limited speed of the machine and motor for which the SLS (Safely Limited Speed) function is
executed.
---Setting range---
0 to 18000 (゜/min)
However, when SP229/bitD is set to "1", the setting range is from -32768 to 32767 (100゜/min).
---Setting range---
0 to 32767 (r/min)
(Note) The value of the safely limited speed and safely limited motor speed must satisfy the following relation.
If this relation is not satisfied, the parameter error (37or E4) will occur. (Error parameter No. is 239.)
Checking this relation is executed when the drive unit is turned ON and parameter is changed and speed
observation mode (states when a speed observation command is turned ON) is entered.
Note that "1 (r/min)" is applied when the calculation result is "0 (r/min)"
491 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
12 Appx. 3: Protection Function
IB-1501229-F 492
13
Appx. 4: Compliance to EC Directives
493 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
13 Appx. 4: Compliance to EC Directives
(1) Configuration
Unit
Electromagnetic
Isolating Circuit breaker contactor
transformer
AC reactor
CB MC M
Insert a type B circuit breaker (RCD) in the power supply side of the unit.
IB-1501229-F 494
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
13 Appx. 4: Compliance to EC Directives
(2) Environment
Use the units under an Overvoltage Category III (MDS-EH)/II (MDS-E) and Pollution Class of 2 or less environment as
stipulated in IEC60664.
(a) To adjust the units to the Overvoltage Category II, insert an isolating transformer of the star connection complying
with EN or IEC standard in the input of the power supply unit.
(b) To adjust the units to the Pollution Class of 2, install the units in a control panel having a structure (IP54 or higher)
in which water, oil, carbon or dust cannot enter.
(4) Earthing
[1] To prevent electric shocks, always connect the servo/spindle drive unit protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal with
mark) to the protective earth (PE) on the control panel.
[2] When connecting the earthing wire to the protective earth (PE) terminal, do not tighten the wire terminals together.
Always connect one wire to one terminal.
PE terminal PE terminal
(5) Wiring
[1] Always use crimp terminals with insulation tubes so that the connected wire does not contact the neighboring
terminals.
Crimp terminal
Insulation tube
Wire
[3] Always install the power supply unit and servo/spindle drive unit on the metal panel.
495 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
13 Appx. 4: Compliance to EC Directives
R L1 TE1 LV Spindle
MV Servo
motor motor
S L2 TE1 LW PLG MW Motor side
TE1 encoder
T L3
L+ TE2 L+
L+
TE2 TE2
MC MC1
L- L- L- LU
CN23
Ground (PE) MC2 Servo
LV
motor
L11 L11 TE3 L11
TE3 LW Motor side
TE3 encoder
L21 L21 L21
Circuit
protector
CN41
CN41
R1 R1
AC TE5
Circuit reactor Contactor R2 R2
protector
R L1
S L2 TE1
T L3
L+ TE2 TE2
L+ L+ L+ TE2
TE2
MC MC1 L- L-
CN23 L- L-
Ground
MC2
TE3 TE3
L11 TE3 L11 L11 OUT- L11 TE3
L1
L2 TE1
L3
Circuit
protector Ground Ground Ground Ground
IB-1501229-F 496
14
Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
497 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
14.1 Introduction
As the NC unit is a component designed to control machine tools, it is believed to be out of the direct EMC Instruction subject.
However, we would like to introduce the following measure plans to backup EMC Instruction compliance of the machine tool
as the NC unit is a major component of the machine tools.
[1] Methods for installation in control/operation panel
[2] Methods of wiring cable outside of panel
[3] Introduction of countermeasure parts
Mitsubishi is carrying out tests to confirm the compliance to the EMC Standards under the environment described in this
manual. However, the level of the noise will differ according to the equipment type and layout, control panel structure and
wiring lead-in, etc. Thus, we ask that the final noise level be confirmed by the machine tool builder.
For measures for CNC, refer to "EMC INSTALLATION GUIDELINES" of each NC Connection Manual.
Standards for
Generic
Class Name Details determining test
Standard
and measurement
Radiated noise Electromagnetic noise radiated through the air EN61000-6-4
(General
industrial
Emission Electromagnetic noise discharged from power machine) -----
Conductive noise
line EN61800-3
(Motor
control unit)
Static electricity electrical (Example) Withstand level of discharge of
EN61000-4-2
discharge immunity test electricity charged in a human body.
Radiated radio-frequency magnetic (Example) Simulation of immunity from digital
EN61000-4-3
field immunity test wireless transmitters
Electrical fast transient/burst (Example) Withstand level of noise from relays
EN61000-6-2 EN61000-4-4
immunity test or connecting/disconnecting live wires
(General
Immunity to conducted disturbance
(Example) Withstand level of noise entering industrial
induced by radio-frequency EN61000-4-6
Immunity through power line, etc. machine)
magnetic field
EN61800-3
Power supply frequency field (Motor
(Example) 50/60Hz power frequency noise EN61000-4-8
immunity test control unit)
Immunity test for voltage dip, short-
time power failure and voltage (Example) Power voltage drop withstand level EN61000-4-11
fluctuation
(Example) Withstand level of noise caused by
Surge immunity test EN61000-4-5
lightning
IB-1501229-F 498
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
Max. joining
Painting mask clearance 20cm or less
[3] Plate the earth plate (with nickel, tin), and connect the connections with a low impedance.
[4] If there is a opening on the panel surface, such as the ventilation holes, cover it with a metal plate or expanded
metal.
Make sure not to connect using metal or a conductor without peeling off the surface, which results in an insufficient
electrical connection. (ex. connection by putting painted surfaces together)
Opening
3cm∼5cm
499 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
Control panel
EMI gasket
Packing
Door
[5] As a method other than the above, the control panel unit and door can be connected with a plain braided wire. In
this case, the panel and door should be contacted at as many points as possible.
Radiated
Radiated noise
noise Shielding
plate
Power Power
Breaker AC input line filter Breaker AC input
line filter
The power supply line noise is eliminated Use a metal plate, etc., for the shielding
by the filter, but cable contains noise partition. Make sure not to create a
again because of the noise radiated in the clearance.
control panel.
IB-1501229-F 500
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
Noise Noise
[2] The noise from other devices will enter the cable and be discharged externally, so avoid internal wiring near the
openings.
Noise
[3] Connect the control device earthing terminal and earthing plate with a thick wire. Take care to the leading of the
wire.
POINT
1. When leading the cables, including the grounding wire (FG), outside of the panel, clamp the cables near the panel outlet
(recommendation: within 10cm).
2. When using a metal duct or conduit, the cables do not need to be clamped near the panel outlet.
3. When leading cables not having shields outside the panel, follow the instructions given for each cable. (Installation of a
ferrite core, etc., may be required.)
501 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
Conduit connector
As close Cannon
10cm or less as possible
To drive unit connector Cannon
To drive unit
connector
Conduit
Servo motor Servo motor
Shield cable Cabtyre cable
[1] Use four wires (3-phase + earthing) for the power cable that are completely shielded and free from breaks.
[2] Earth the shield on both the control panel side and motor chassis side. The shield earth position on the drive unit
side must be 10cm or less from the control panel.
[3] Earth the shield with a metal P clip or U clip.
(A cable clamp fitting can be used depending on the wire size.)
[4] Directly earth the shield. Do not solder the braided shield onto a wire and earth the end of the wire.
Solder
Earth example with P clip Earth example with U clip Earth example with wire soldering
[5] When not using a shield cable for the power cable, use a conventional cabtyre cable. Use a metal conduit outside
the cable.
[6] Earth the power cable on the control panel side at the contact surface of the conduit connector and control panel.
(Mask the side wall of the control panel with paint.)
[7] Follow the treatment shown in the example for the conduit connector to earth the power cable on the motor side.
(Example: Use a clamp fitting, etc.)
Clamp fitting
Conduit
IB-1501229-F 502
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
Control panel
As close
10cm or less as possible
To drive unit Connector
Control panel
Optical cable
Control unit
Ferrite core
Magnetic
To motor encoder contactor
ACL
Shield earth
Power
To motor power supply
EMC filter
Ferrite core
503 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
Earthing plate
30
Cable
Clamp fitting L1
B ± 0.3
C
A
(Fitting A, B) L2
24 - 0.2
0
40
35
3
6
Shield sheath
24+0.3
7
0
1RWH
M4 screw 6 22
View of clamp section
35
[Unit: mm]
11
(Note 1) Screw hole for wiring to earthing plate in cabinet.
(Note 2) The earthing plate thickness is 1.6mm.
A B C Enclosed fittings
Ground Plate #D 100 86 30 Clamp fitting A x 2
Ground Plate #E 70 56 - Clamp fitting B x 1
L1 L2
(maximum dimension when it is open) (reference dimension)
Clamp fitting A 25 (77)
Clamp fitting B 12 (54)
Lead through one time Lead through two times Lead through three times
(one turn) (two turns) (three turns)
IB-1501229-F 504
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
B ȭC B ȭC
D
Fig.1 Fig.2
[Unit: mm]
Applicable
Part name Fig A B C D E Mass
cable outline
ZCAT3035-1330(-BK)*1 1 39±1 34±1 13 30 - 13max. 63
ZCAT2035-0930-M(-BK) 2 35±1 28±1 9±1 19.5±1 17.4±1 6 to 9 22
*1 A fixing band is enclosed when shipped.
Contact:
TDK Corporation
http://www.global.tdk.com/
[Unit: mm]
Contact:
KITAGAWA INDUSTRIES CO.,LTD.
http://www.kitagawa-ind.com/eng/
505 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
■ Features
(a) 3-phase 3-wire type (500V series)
(b) Compatible with 200V/400V
(c) Compliant with EU Standards EN55011 (Group 1 Class A)
(d) Downsized for the space-saving book type
■ Application
(a) Applications such as large machine tool, inverter, servo, etc.
■ Specifications
HF3000C-SZA Series
Part name HF3010 HF3020 HF3030 HF3040 HF3050 HF3060 HF3080 HF3100 HF3150 HF3200 HF3250 HF3300
C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA C-SZA
Rated voltage 3-phase 3-wire type 500VAC (530VAC max 50/60Hz)
Rated current 10A 20A 30A 40A 50A 60A 80A 100A 150A 200A 250A 300A
Leakage
7mA max 400VAC 50Hz(by UL1283)
current
Ambient temp -20 to 50°C
Safety
CSA, UL1283/EN60939-2
standards
Vibration
Resistance Frequency: 10Hz to 55Hz Acceleration rate: 9.8m/s2
< Circuit diagram > < Attenuation > Typical example: HF3150C-SZA
■ Outline dimensions
IB-1501229-F 506
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
Surge
Rated Voltage
withstand Service
Part name voltage protection
level temperature
50/60Hz level
8/20 µs
RSPD-250-U4 3AC 250V 1300V 2500A -40 to 70°C
Surge
Rated Voltage
withstand Service
Part name voltage protection
level temperature
50/60Hz level
8/20µs
RSPD-500-U4 3AC 500V 2000V 2500A -40 to 70°C
[Unit: mm]
Outline dimension drawings Circuit diagram
Resin
Connection cable
Case
507 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
14 Appx. 5: EMC Installation Guidelines
Circuit
Transformer protector
NC unit
Other device
(panel power
supply, etc.)
Contactor
Circuit
protector
Other device
(panel power
supply, etc.)
Surge absorber
A (Protection across phases/
Protection across each phase’s grounding)
Grounding
Grounding plate
CAUTION
1. The wires from the surge absorber should be connected without extensions.
2. If the surge absorber cannot be installed just with the enclosed wires, keep the wiring length of A to 2m or less. If the
wires are long, the surge absorber's performance may drop and inhibit protection of the devices in the panel.
3. Surge absorber to be selected varies depending on input power voltage.
4. Do not insert the surge absorber in the place with a lot of harmonic components.
IB-1501229-F 508
15
Appx. 6: Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure
Guidelines
509 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
15 Appx. 6: Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure Guidelines
Higher Harmonic Suppression Guidelines were set in September 1994 by the Ministry of International Trade and
Industry's Agency of Natural Resources and Energy.
• Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure Guidelines for Household Appliances and General-purpose Products
• Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure Guidelines for Consumers Receiving High Voltage or Special High Voltage
Power
IB-1501229-F 510
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
15 Appx. 6: Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure Guidelines
If the total equivalent capacity Po exceeds the limit value given in (Table 3), proceed to "(2) Calculating the higher
harmonic current flow".
Measures are not required if the value is not exceeded.
511 IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
15 Appx. 6: Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure Guidelines
Obtain the upper limit of the higher harmonic current flow (judgment value) for each order.
(The contracted electricity must be known for this.)
Upper limit of higher harmonic current flow (mA) = Contracted electricity, flow upper limit value
Flow upper limit value :
Insert a value from Table 5 according to the higher harmonic order to be calculated.
Obtain the higher harmonic current flow for each order using the following expression.
Higher harmonic current flow (mA) = (a • Pi), Device's maximum operation rate, target order
Device's maximum operation rate : The user must set the operation rate.
Target order : Insert a value from Table 6 according to the higher harmonic order to be calculated.
IB-1501229-F 512
<Form 1>
Higher harmonic generating device's higher harmonic current flow calculation form (Part 1)
Date of application
Incoming Contracted Application No.
User
Industry power kV kW
name voltage electricity
Date of acceptance
Step 1: Details of higher harmonic generating device Step 2: Calculation of higher harmonic current flow rate
Higher harmonic 6-pulse Rated current Device's
generating device Circuit 6-pulse Higher harmonic current flow per order
Rated Total value for
Qty. of equivalent incoming maximum
capacity capacity type clas- calculation
devices capacity power voltage operation
No. sification coefficient 5th- 7th- 11th- 13th- 17th- 19th- 23rd- 25th-
Device name Maker Type (kVA) Pi (kVA) [Ki x Pi] conversion rate order order order order order order order order
No. Ki
(kVA) [a x Pi] (mA) (%)
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
1
2
3
4
5
(3) Higher harmonic current flow calculation form
6
7
8
513
9
15 Appx. 6: Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure Guidelines
10
11
12
13
14
15
A higher harmonic current flow calculation form is shown below for reference.
IB-1501229-F
MDS-E/EH Series Instruction Manual
15 Appx. 6: Higher Harmonic Suppression Measure Guidelines
IB-1501229-F 514
Revision History
AMERICA EUROPE
MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC AUTOMATION INC. (AMERICA FA CENTER) MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC EUROPE B.V.
Central Region Service Center (Chicago) European Service Headquarters (Dusseldorf, GERMANY)
500 CORPORATE WOODS PARKWAY, VERNON HILLS, ILLINOIS 60061, U.S.A. Mitsubishi-Electric-Platz 1 40882 RATINGEN, GERMANY
TEL: +1-847-478-2500 / FAX: +1-847-478-2650 TEL: +49-2102-486-5000 / FAX: +49-2102-486-5910
Minneapolis, MN Service Satellite
Detroit, MI Service Satellite South Germany Service Center (Stuttgart)
Grand Rapids, MI Service Satellite SCHELMENWASENSTRASSE 16-20, 70567 STUTTGART, GERMANY
Lima, OH Service Satellite TEL: + 49-711-770598-123 / FAX: +49-711-770598-141
Cleveland, OH Service Satellite
Indianapolis, IN Service Satellite France Service Center (Paris)
St. Louis, MO Service Satellite 25, BOULEVARD DES BOUVETS, 92741 NANTERRE CEDEX FRANCE
TEL: +33-1-41-02-83-13 / FAX: +33-1-49-01-07-25
South/East Region Service Center (Georgia)
1845 SATTELITE BOULEVARD STE. 450, DULUTH, GEORGIA 30097, U.S.A. France Service Satellite (Lyon)
TEL +1-678-258-4529 / FAX +1-678-258-4519 120, ALLEE JACQUES MONOD 69800 SAINT PRIEST FRANCE
Charleston, SC Service Satellite TEL: +33-1-41-02-83-13 / FAX: +33-1-49-01-07-25
Charlotte, NC Service Satellite
Raleigh, NC Service Satellite Italy Service Center (Milan)
Dallas, TX Service Satellite PALAZZO SIRIO INGRESSO 1, VIA COLLEONI, 7, 20864 AGRATE BRIANZA(MI), ITALY
Houston, TX Service Satellite TEL: +39-039-6053-342 / FAX: +39-039-6053-206
Hartford, CT Service Satellite
Knoxville, TN Service Satellite Italy Service Satellite (Padova)
Nashville, TN Service Satellite VIA G. SAVELLI, 24 - 35129 PADOVA, ITALY
Baltimore, MD Service Satellite TEL: +39-039-6053-342 / FAX: +39-039-6053-206
Pittsburg, PA Service Satellite
Newark, NJ Service Satellite U.K. Service Center
Syracuse, NY Service Satellite TRAVELLERS LANE, HATFIELD, HERTFORDSHIRE, AL10 8XB, U.K.
Ft. Lauderdale, FL Service Satellite TEL: +49-2102-486-5000 / FAX: +49-2102-486-5910
Lafayette, LA Service Satellite
Spain Service Center
Western Region Service Center (California) CTRA. RUBI, 76-80 8174 SAINT CUGAT DEL VALLES, BARCELONA SPAIN
5900-B KATELLA AVE. - 5900-A KATELLA AVE. CYPRESS, CALIFORNIA 90630, U.S.A. TEL: +34-935-65-2236 / FAX: +34-935-89-1579
TEL: +1-714-699-2625 / FAX: +1-847-478-2650
San Francisco, CA Service Satellite Poland Service Center
Seattle, WA Service Satellite UL.KRAKOWSKA 50, 32-083 BALICE, POLAND
Denver, CO Service Satellite TEL: +48-12-347-6500 / FAX: +48-12-630-4701
MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC ASIA PTE. LTD. (ASEAN FA CENTER) MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC AUTOMATION (CHINA) LTD. (CHINA FA CENTER)
Singapore Service Center China Shanghai Service Center
307 ALEXANDRA ROAD #05-01/02 MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC BUILDING SINGAPORE 159943 1-3,5-10,18-23/F, NO.1386 HONG QIAO ROAD, CHANG NING QU,
TEL: +65-6473-2308 / FAX: +65-6476-7439 SHANGHAI 200336, CHINA
TEL: +86-21-2322-3030 / FAX: +86-21-2322-3000*8422
Philippines Service Center China Qingdao Service Center
Flexible Automation system corporation (Service Partner) China Suzhou Service Center
UNIT NO.411, ALABAMG CORPORATE CENTER KM 25. WEST SERVICE ROAD China Wuhan Service Center
SOUTH SUPERHIGHWAY, ALABAMG MUNTINLUPA METRO MANILA, PHILIPPINES 1771 China Ningbo Service Center
TEL: +63-2-807-2416 / FAX: +63-2-807-2417 China Ningbo Service Partner
China Jinan Service Partner
China Hangzhou Service Partner
VIETNAM China Suzhou Service Partner
West India Service Center (Pune) MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC AUSTRALIA PTY. LTD.
ICC-Devi GAURAV TECHNOLOGY PARK, UNIT NO.402, FOURTH FLOOR, NORTH WING, Oceania Service Center
SURVEY NUMBER 191-192 (P), NEXT to INDIAN CARD CLOTHING COMPANY Ltd, 348 VICTORIA ROAD, RYDALMERE, N.S.W. 2116 AUSTRALIA
OPP. VALLABH NAGAR, PIMPRI, PUNE- 411 018, MAHARASHTRA, INDIA TEL: +61-2-9684-7269/ FAX: +61-2-9684-7245
TEL : +91-20-6819 2274 / FAX : +91-20-4624 2100
Kolhapur Service Satellite
Aurangabad Service Satellite
Mumbai Service Satellite
Every effort has been made to keep up with software and hardware revisions in the
contents described in this manual. However, please understand that in some
unavoidable cases simultaneous revision is not possible.
Please contact your Mitsubishi Electric dealer with any questions or comments
regarding the use of this product.
Duplication Prohibited
This manual may not be reproduced in any form, in part or in whole, without written
permission from Mitsubishi Electric Corporation.